annotate man/misc.texi @ 70268:8fb69c1e87e8

(abbrev-mode): Tighten the safety predicate.
author Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
date Sat, 29 Apr 2006 13:56:50 +0000
parents 13078b41e1eb
children 17cc79655a4b 72dea2ff0142
Ignore whitespace changes - Everywhere: Within whitespace: At end of lines:
rev   line source
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1 @c This is part of the Emacs manual.
62473
ee50af163f00 (Emacs Server): Add menu description.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents: 61880
diff changeset
2 @c Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1987, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1997, 2000, 2001,
68639
dc2d5a6655a3 Update years in copyright notice; nfc.
Thien-Thi Nguyen <ttn@gnuvola.org>
parents: 68546
diff changeset
3 @c 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
4 @c See file emacs.texi for copying conditions.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
5 @iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
6 @chapter Miscellaneous Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
7
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
8 This chapter contains several brief topics that do not fit anywhere
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
9 else: reading netnews, running shell commands and shell subprocesses,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
10 using a single shared Emacs for utilities that expect to run an editor
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
11 as a subprocess, printing hardcopy, sorting text, narrowing display to
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
12 part of the buffer, editing double-column files and binary files,
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
13 saving an Emacs session for later resumption, following hyperlinks,
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
14 browsing images, emulating other editors, and various diversions and
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
15 amusements.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
16
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
17 @end iftex
56807
d2c0e48f4d5a Adapt sectioning in Info to the node structure.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 56222
diff changeset
18
d2c0e48f4d5a Adapt sectioning in Info to the node structure.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 56222
diff changeset
19 @ifnottex
d2c0e48f4d5a Adapt sectioning in Info to the node structure.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 56222
diff changeset
20 @raisesections
d2c0e48f4d5a Adapt sectioning in Info to the node structure.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 56222
diff changeset
21 @end ifnottex
d2c0e48f4d5a Adapt sectioning in Info to the node structure.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 56222
diff changeset
22
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
23 @node Gnus, Shell, Calendar/Diary, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
24 @section Gnus
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
25 @cindex Gnus
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
26 @cindex reading netnews
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
27
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
28 Gnus is an Emacs package primarily designed for reading and posting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
29 Usenet news. It can also be used to read and respond to messages from a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
30 number of other sources---mail, remote directories, digests, and so on.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
31
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
32 Here we introduce Gnus and describe several basic features.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
33 @ifinfo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
34 For full details, see @ref{Top, Gnus,, gnus, The Gnus Manual}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
35 @end ifinfo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
36 @iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
37 For full details on Gnus, type @kbd{M-x info} and then select the Gnus
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
38 manual.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
39 @end iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
40
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
41 @findex gnus
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
42 To start Gnus, type @kbd{M-x gnus @key{RET}}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
43
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
44 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
45 * Buffers of Gnus:: The group, summary, and article buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
46 * Gnus Startup:: What you should know about starting Gnus.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
47 * Summary of Gnus:: A short description of the basic Gnus commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
48 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
49
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
50 @node Buffers of Gnus
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
51 @subsection Gnus Buffers
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
52
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
53 Unlike most Emacs packages, Gnus uses several buffers to display
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
54 information and to receive commands. The three Gnus buffers users use
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
55 most are the @dfn{group buffer}, the @dfn{summary buffer} and the
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
56 @dfn{article buffer}.
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
57
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
58 The @dfn{group buffer} contains a list of newsgroups. This is the
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
59 first buffer Gnus displays when it starts up. It normally displays
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
60 only the groups to which you subscribe and that contain unread
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
61 articles. Use this buffer to select a specific group.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
62
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
63 The @dfn{summary buffer} lists one line for each article in a single
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
64 group. By default, the author, the subject and the line number are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
65 displayed for each article, but this is customizable, like most aspects
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
66 of Gnus display. The summary buffer is created when you select a group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
67 in the group buffer, and is killed when you exit the group. Use this
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
68 buffer to select an article.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
69
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
70 The @dfn{article buffer} displays the article. In normal Gnus usage,
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
71 you see this buffer but you don't select it---all useful
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
72 article-oriented commands work in the summary buffer. But you can
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
73 select the article buffer, and execute all Gnus commands from that
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
74 buffer, if you want to.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
75
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
76 @node Gnus Startup
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
77 @subsection When Gnus Starts Up
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
78
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
79 At startup, Gnus reads your @file{.newsrc} news initialization file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
80 and attempts to communicate with the local news server, which is a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
81 repository of news articles. The news server need not be the same
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
82 computer you are logged in on.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
83
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
84 If you start Gnus and connect to the server, but do not see any
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
85 newsgroups listed in the group buffer, type @kbd{L} or @kbd{A k} to get
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
86 a listing of all the groups. Then type @kbd{u} to toggle
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
87 subscription to groups.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
88
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
89 The first time you start Gnus, Gnus subscribes you to a few selected
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
90 groups. All other groups start out as @dfn{killed groups} for you; you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
91 can list them with @kbd{A k}. All new groups that subsequently come to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
92 exist at the news server become @dfn{zombie groups} for you; type @kbd{A
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
93 z} to list them. You can subscribe to a group shown in these lists
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
94 using the @kbd{u} command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
95
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
96 When you quit Gnus with @kbd{q}, it automatically records in your
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
97 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.eld} initialization files the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
98 subscribed or unsubscribed status of all groups. You should normally
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
99 not edit these files manually, but you may if you know how.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
100
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
101 @node Summary of Gnus
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
102 @subsection Summary of Gnus Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
103
38599
29e540f10e62 Proofreading changes from JDonner <jdonner0@earthlink.net>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38467
diff changeset
104 Reading news is a two-step process:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
105
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
106 @enumerate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
107 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
108 Choose a group in the group buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
109
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
110 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
111 Select articles from the summary buffer. Each article selected is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
112 displayed in the article buffer in a large window, below the summary
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
113 buffer in its small window.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
114 @end enumerate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
115
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
116 Each Gnus buffer has its own special commands; the meanings of any
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
117 given key in the various Gnus buffers are usually analogous, even if
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
118 not identical. Here are commands for the group and summary buffers:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
119
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
120 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
121 @kindex q @r{(Gnus Group mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
122 @findex gnus-group-exit
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
123 @item q
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
124 In the group buffer, update your @file{.newsrc} initialization file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
125 and quit Gnus.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
126
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
127 In the summary buffer, exit the current group and return to the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
128 group buffer. Thus, typing @kbd{q} twice quits Gnus.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
129
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
130 @kindex L @r{(Gnus Group mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
131 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
132 @item L
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
133 In the group buffer, list all the groups available on your news
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
134 server (except those you have killed). This may be a long list!
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
135
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
136 @kindex l @r{(Gnus Group mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
137 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
138 @item l
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
139 In the group buffer, list only the groups to which you subscribe and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
140 which contain unread articles.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
141
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
142 @kindex u @r{(Gnus Group mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
143 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
144 @cindex subscribe groups
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
145 @cindex unsubscribe groups
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
146 @item u
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
147 In the group buffer, unsubscribe from (or subscribe to) the group listed
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
148 in the line that point is on. When you quit Gnus by typing @kbd{q},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
149 Gnus lists in your @file{.newsrc} file which groups you have subscribed
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
150 to. The next time you start Gnus, you won't see this group,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
151 because Gnus normally displays only subscribed-to groups.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
152
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
153 @kindex C-k @r{(Gnus)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
154 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
155 @item C-k
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
156 In the group buffer, ``kill'' the current line's group---don't
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
157 even list it in @file{.newsrc} from now on. This affects future
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
158 Gnus sessions as well as the present session.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
159
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
160 When you quit Gnus by typing @kbd{q}, Gnus writes information
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
161 in the file @file{.newsrc} describing all newsgroups except those you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
162 have ``killed.''
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
163
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
164 @kindex SPC @r{(Gnus)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
165 @findex gnus-group-read-group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
166 @item @key{SPC}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
167 In the group buffer, select the group on the line under the cursor
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
168 and display the first unread article in that group.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
169
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
170 @need 1000
49600
23a1cea22d13 Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 47650
diff changeset
171 In the summary buffer,
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
172
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
173 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
174 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
175 Select the article on the line under the cursor if none is selected.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
176
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
177 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
178 Scroll the text of the selected article (if there is one).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
179
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
180 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
181 Select the next unread article if at the end of the current article.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
182 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
183
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
184 Thus, you can move through all the articles by repeatedly typing @key{SPC}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
185
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
186 @kindex DEL @r{(Gnus)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
187 @item @key{DEL}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
188 In the group buffer, move point to the previous group containing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
189 unread articles.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
190
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
191 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
192 In the summary buffer, scroll the text of the article backwards.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
193
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
194 @kindex n @r{(Gnus)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
195 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
196 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
197 @item n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
198 Move point to the next unread group, or select the next unread article.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
199
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
200 @kindex p @r{(Gnus)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
201 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
202 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
203 @item p
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
204 Move point to the previous unread group, or select the previous
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
205 unread article.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
206
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
207 @kindex C-n @r{(Gnus Group mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
208 @findex gnus-group-next-group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
209 @kindex C-p @r{(Gnus Group mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
210 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
211 @kindex C-n @r{(Gnus Summary mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
212 @findex gnus-summary-next-subject
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
213 @kindex C-p @r{(Gnus Summary mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
214 @findex gnus-summary-prev-subject
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
215 @item C-n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
216 @itemx C-p
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
217 Move point to the next or previous item, even if it is marked as read.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
218 This does not select the article or group on that line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
219
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
220 @kindex s @r{(Gnus Summary mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
221 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
222 @item s
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
223 In the summary buffer, do an incremental search of the current text in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
224 the article buffer, just as if you switched to the article buffer and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
225 typed @kbd{C-s}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
226
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
227 @kindex M-s @r{(Gnus Summary mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
228 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
229 @item M-s @var{regexp} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
230 In the summary buffer, search forward for articles containing a match
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
231 for @var{regexp}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
232
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
233 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
234
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
235 @ignore
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
236 @node Where to Look
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
237 @subsection Where to Look Further
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
238
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
239 @c Too many references to the name of the manual if done with xref in TeX!
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
240 Gnus is powerful and customizable. Here are references to a few
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
241 @ifinfo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
242 additional topics:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
243
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
244 @end ifinfo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
245 @iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
246 additional topics in @cite{The Gnus Manual}:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
247
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
248 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
249 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
250 Follow discussions on specific topics.@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
251 See section ``Threading.''
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
252
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
253 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
254 Read digests. See section ``Document Groups.''
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
255
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
256 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
257 Refer to and jump to the parent of the current article.@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
258 See section ``Finding the Parent.''
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
259
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
260 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
261 Refer to articles by using Message-IDs included in the messages.@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
262 See section ``Article Keymap.''
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
263
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
264 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
265 Save articles. See section ``Saving Articles.''
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
266
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
267 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
268 Have Gnus score articles according to various criteria, like author
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
269 name, subject, or string in the body of the articles.@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
270 See section ``Scoring.''
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
271
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
272 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
273 Send an article to a newsgroup.@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
274 See section ``Composing Messages.''
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
275 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
276 @end iftex
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
277 @ifinfo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
278 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
279 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
280 Follow discussions on specific topics.@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
281 @xref{Threading, , Reading Based on Conversation Threads,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
282 gnus, The Gnus Manual}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
283
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
284 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
285 Read digests. @xref{Document Groups, , , gnus, The Gnus Manual}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
286
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
287 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
288 Refer to and jump to the parent of the current article.@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
289 @xref{Finding the Parent, , , gnus, The Gnus Manual}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
290
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
291 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
292 Refer to articles by using Message-IDs included in the messages.@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
293 @xref{Article Keymap, , , gnus, The Gnus Manual}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
294
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
295 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
296 Save articles. @xref{Saving Articles, , , gnus, The Gnus Manual}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
297
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
298 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
299 Have Gnus score articles according to various criteria, like author
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
300 name, subject, or string in the body of the articles.@*
49600
23a1cea22d13 Trailing whitespace deleted.
Juanma Barranquero <lekktu@gmail.com>
parents: 47650
diff changeset
301 @xref{Scoring, , , gnus, The Gnus Manual}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
302
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
303 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
304 Send an article to a newsgroup.@*
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
305 @xref{Composing Messages, , , gnus, The Gnus Manual}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
306 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
307 @end ifinfo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
308 @end ignore
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
309
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
310 @node Shell, Emacs Server, Gnus, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
311 @section Running Shell Commands from Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
312 @cindex subshell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
313 @cindex shell commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
314
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
315 Emacs has commands for passing single command lines to inferior shell
33382
fe183c1fbf56 xref eshell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 32637
diff changeset
316 processes; it can also run a shell interactively with input and output
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
317 to an Emacs buffer named @samp{*shell*} or run a shell inside a terminal
33382
fe183c1fbf56 xref eshell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 32637
diff changeset
318 emulator window.
fe183c1fbf56 xref eshell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 32637
diff changeset
319
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
320 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
321 @item M-! @var{cmd} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
322 Run the shell command line @var{cmd} and display the output
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
323 (@code{shell-command}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
324 @item M-| @var{cmd} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
325 Run the shell command line @var{cmd} with region contents as input;
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
326 optionally replace the region with the output
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
327 (@code{shell-command-on-region}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
328 @item M-x shell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
329 Run a subshell with input and output through an Emacs buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
330 You can then give commands interactively.
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
331 @item M-x term
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
332 Run a subshell with input and output through an Emacs buffer.
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
333 You can then give commands interactively.
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
334 Full terminal emulation is available.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
335 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
336
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
337 @kbd{M-x eshell} invokes a shell implemented entirely in Emacs. It
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
338 is documented in a separate manual. @xref{Top,Eshell,Eshell, eshell,
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
339 Eshell: The Emacs Shell}.
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
340
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
341 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
342 * Single Shell:: How to run one shell command and return.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
343 * Interactive Shell:: Permanent shell taking input via Emacs.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
344 * Shell Mode:: Special Emacs commands used with permanent shell.
61880
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
345 * Shell Prompts:: Two ways to recognize shell prompts.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
346 * History: Shell History. Repeating previous commands in a shell buffer.
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
347 * Directory Tracking:: Keeping track when the subshell changes directory.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
348 * Options: Shell Options. Options for customizing Shell mode.
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
349 * Terminal emulator:: An Emacs window as a terminal emulator.
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
350 * Term Mode:: Special Emacs commands used in Term mode.
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
351 * Paging in Term:: Paging in the terminal emulator.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
352 * Remote Host:: Connecting to another computer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
353 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
354
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
355 @node Single Shell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
356 @subsection Single Shell Commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
357
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
358 @kindex M-!
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
359 @findex shell-command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
360 @kbd{M-!} (@code{shell-command}) reads a line of text using the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
361 minibuffer and executes it as a shell command in a subshell made just
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
362 for that command. Standard input for the command comes from the null
37846
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
363 device. If the shell command produces any output, the output appears
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
364 either in the echo area (if it is short), or in an Emacs buffer named
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
365 @samp{*Shell Command Output*}, which is displayed in another window
38132
1471b85b3b80 Give examples for M-! and M-|.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38025
diff changeset
366 but not selected (if the output is long).
1471b85b3b80 Give examples for M-! and M-|.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38025
diff changeset
367
1471b85b3b80 Give examples for M-! and M-|.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38025
diff changeset
368 For instance, one way to decompress a file @file{foo.gz} from Emacs
1471b85b3b80 Give examples for M-! and M-|.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38025
diff changeset
369 is to type @kbd{M-! gunzip foo.gz @key{RET}}. That shell command
1471b85b3b80 Give examples for M-! and M-|.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38025
diff changeset
370 normally creates the file @file{foo} and produces no terminal output.
1471b85b3b80 Give examples for M-! and M-|.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38025
diff changeset
371
1471b85b3b80 Give examples for M-! and M-|.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38025
diff changeset
372 A numeric argument, as in @kbd{M-1 M-!}, says to insert terminal
1471b85b3b80 Give examples for M-! and M-|.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38025
diff changeset
373 output into the current buffer instead of a separate buffer. It puts
1471b85b3b80 Give examples for M-! and M-|.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38025
diff changeset
374 point before the output, and sets the mark after the output. For
38786
4d3fd773cd30 Minor cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38740
diff changeset
375 instance, @kbd{M-1 M-! gunzip < foo.gz @key{RET}} would insert the
38132
1471b85b3b80 Give examples for M-! and M-|.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38025
diff changeset
376 uncompressed equivalent of @file{foo.gz} into the current buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
377
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
378 If the shell command line ends in @samp{&}, it runs asynchronously.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
379 For a synchronous shell command, @code{shell-command} returns the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
380 command's exit status (0 means success), when it is called from a Lisp
38132
1471b85b3b80 Give examples for M-! and M-|.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38025
diff changeset
381 program. You do not get any status information for an asynchronous
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
382 command, since it hasn't finished yet when @code{shell-command} returns.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
383
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
384 @kindex M-|
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
385 @findex shell-command-on-region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
386 @kbd{M-|} (@code{shell-command-on-region}) is like @kbd{M-!} but
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
387 passes the contents of the region as the standard input to the shell
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
388 command, instead of no input. With a numeric argument, meaning insert
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
389 the output in the current buffer, it deletes the old region and the
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
390 output replaces it as the contents of the region. It returns the
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
391 command's exit status, like @kbd{M-!}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
392
60432
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
393 One use for @kbd{M-|} is to run @code{gpg} to see what keys are in
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
394 the buffer. For instance, if the buffer contains a GPG key, type
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
395 @kbd{C-x h M-| gpg @key{RET}} to feed the entire buffer contents to
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
396 the @code{gpg} program. That program will ignore everything except
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
397 the encoded keys, and will output a list of the keys the buffer
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
398 contains.
38132
1471b85b3b80 Give examples for M-! and M-|.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38025
diff changeset
399
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
400 @vindex shell-file-name
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
401 Both @kbd{M-!} and @kbd{M-|} use @code{shell-file-name} to specify
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
402 the shell to use. This variable is initialized based on your
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
403 @env{SHELL} environment variable when Emacs is started. If the file
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
404 name is relative, Emacs searches the directories in the list
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
405 @code{exec-path}; this list is initialized based on the environment
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
406 variable @env{PATH} when Emacs is started. Your @file{.emacs} file
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
407 can override either or both of these default initializations.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
408
60432
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
409 Both @kbd{M-!} and @kbd{M-|} wait for the shell command to complete,
61880
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
410 unless you end the command with @samp{&} to make it asynchronous. To
60432
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
411 stop waiting, type @kbd{C-g} to quit; that terminates the shell
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
412 command with the signal @code{SIGINT}---the same signal that @kbd{C-c}
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
413 normally generates in the shell. Emacs then waits until the command
60432
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
414 actually terminates. If the shell command doesn't stop (because it
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
415 ignores the @code{SIGINT} signal), type @kbd{C-g} again; this sends
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
416 the command a @code{SIGKILL} signal which is impossible to ignore.
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
417
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
418 Asynchronous commands ending in @samp{&} feed their output into
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
419 the buffer @samp{*Async Shell Command*}. Output arrives in that
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
420 buffer regardless of whether it is visible in a window.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
421
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
422 To specify a coding system for @kbd{M-!} or @kbd{M-|}, use the command
68546
1a876a016f0a (Single Shell, Interactive Shell): Fix xrefs.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 66783
diff changeset
423 @kbd{C-x @key{RET} c} immediately beforehand. @xref{Communication Coding}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
424
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
425 @vindex shell-command-default-error-buffer
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
426 Error output from these commands is normally intermixed with the
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
427 regular output. But if the variable
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
428 @code{shell-command-default-error-buffer} has a string as value, and
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
429 it's the name of a buffer, @kbd{M-!} and @kbd{M-|} insert error output
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
430 before point in that buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
431
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
432 @node Interactive Shell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
433 @subsection Interactive Inferior Shell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
434
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
435 @findex shell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
436 To run a subshell interactively, putting its typescript in an Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
437 buffer, use @kbd{M-x shell}. This creates (or reuses) a buffer named
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
438 @samp{*shell*} and runs a subshell with input coming from and output going
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
439 to that buffer. That is to say, any ``terminal output'' from the subshell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
440 goes into the buffer, advancing point, and any ``terminal input'' for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
441 the subshell comes from text in the buffer. To give input to the subshell,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
442 go to the end of the buffer and type the input, terminated by @key{RET}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
443
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
444 Emacs does not wait for the subshell to do anything. You can switch
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
445 windows or buffers and edit them while the shell is waiting, or while it is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
446 running a command. Output from the subshell waits until Emacs has time to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
447 process it; this happens whenever Emacs is waiting for keyboard input or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
448 for time to elapse.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
449
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
450 @cindex @code{comint-highlight-input} face
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
451 @cindex @code{comint-highlight-prompt} face
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
452 Input lines, once you submit them, are displayed using the face
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
453 @code{comint-highlight-input}, and prompts are displayed using the
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
454 face @code{comint-highlight-prompt}. This makes it easier to see
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
455 previous input lines in the buffer. @xref{Faces}.
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
456
38786
4d3fd773cd30 Minor cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38740
diff changeset
457 To make multiple subshells, you can invoke @kbd{M-x shell} with a
4d3fd773cd30 Minor cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38740
diff changeset
458 prefix argument (e.g. @kbd{C-u M-x shell}), which will read a buffer
4d3fd773cd30 Minor cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38740
diff changeset
459 name and create (or reuse) a subshell in that buffer. You can also
4d3fd773cd30 Minor cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38740
diff changeset
460 rename the @samp{*shell*} buffer using @kbd{M-x rename-uniquely}, then
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
461 create a new @samp{*shell*} buffer using plain @kbd{M-x shell}.
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
462 Subshells in different buffers run independently and in parallel.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
463
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
464 @vindex explicit-shell-file-name
38459
08aca6a91513 (Interactive Shell): Document that EMACS is only put into the shell's
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38141
diff changeset
465 @cindex environment variables for subshells
29107
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29083
diff changeset
466 @cindex @env{ESHELL} environment variable
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29083
diff changeset
467 @cindex @env{SHELL} environment variable
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
468 The file name used to load the subshell is the value of the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
469 @code{explicit-shell-file-name}, if that is non-@code{nil}. Otherwise,
29107
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29083
diff changeset
470 the environment variable @env{ESHELL} is used, or the environment
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29083
diff changeset
471 variable @env{SHELL} if there is no @env{ESHELL}. If the file name
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
472 specified is relative, the directories in the list @code{exec-path} are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
473 searched; this list is initialized based on the environment variable
29107
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29083
diff changeset
474 @env{PATH} when Emacs is started. Your @file{.emacs} file can override
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
475 either or both of these default initializations.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
476
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
477 Emacs sends the new shell the contents of the file
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
478 @file{~/.emacs_@var{shellname}} as input, if it exists, where
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
479 @var{shellname} is the name of the file that the shell was loaded
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
480 from. For example, if you use bash, the file sent to it is
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
481 @file{~/.emacs_bash}.
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
482
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
483 To specify a coding system for the shell, you can use the command
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
484 @kbd{C-x @key{RET} c} immediately before @kbd{M-x shell}. You can
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
485 also change the coding system for a running subshell by typing
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
486 @kbd{C-x @key{RET} p} in the shell buffer. @xref{Communication
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
487 Coding}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
488
38459
08aca6a91513 (Interactive Shell): Document that EMACS is only put into the shell's
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38141
diff changeset
489 @cindex @env{EMACS} environment variable
08aca6a91513 (Interactive Shell): Document that EMACS is only put into the shell's
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38141
diff changeset
490 Unless the environment variable @env{EMACS} is already defined,
08aca6a91513 (Interactive Shell): Document that EMACS is only put into the shell's
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38141
diff changeset
491 Emacs defines it in the subshell, with value @code{t}. A shell script
08aca6a91513 (Interactive Shell): Document that EMACS is only put into the shell's
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38141
diff changeset
492 can check this variable to determine whether it has been run from an
08aca6a91513 (Interactive Shell): Document that EMACS is only put into the shell's
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38141
diff changeset
493 Emacs subshell.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
494
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
495 @node Shell Mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
496 @subsection Shell Mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
497 @cindex Shell mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
498 @cindex mode, Shell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
499
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
500 Shell buffers use Shell mode, which defines several special keys
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
501 attached to the @kbd{C-c} prefix. They are chosen to resemble the usual
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
502 editing and job control characters present in shells that are not under
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
503 Emacs, except that you must type @kbd{C-c} first. Here is a complete list
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
504 of the special key bindings of Shell mode:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
505
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
506 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
507 @item @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
508 @kindex RET @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
509 @findex comint-send-input
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
510 At end of buffer send line as input; otherwise, copy current line to
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
511 end of buffer and send it (@code{comint-send-input}). Copying a line
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
512 in this way omits any prompt at the beginning of the line (text output
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
513 by programs preceding your input). @xref{Shell Prompts}, for how
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
514 Shell mode recognizes prompts.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
515
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
516 @item @key{TAB}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
517 @kindex TAB @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
518 @findex comint-dynamic-complete
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
519 Complete the command name or file name before point in the shell buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
520 (@code{comint-dynamic-complete}). @key{TAB} also completes history
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
521 references (@pxref{History References}) and environment variable names.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
522
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
523 @vindex shell-completion-fignore
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
524 @vindex comint-completion-fignore
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
525 The variable @code{shell-completion-fignore} specifies a list of file
37846
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
526 name extensions to ignore in Shell mode completion. The default
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
527 setting is @code{nil}, but some users prefer @code{("~" "#" "%")} to
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
528 ignore file names ending in @samp{~}, @samp{#} or @samp{%}. Other
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
529 related Comint modes use the variable @code{comint-completion-fignore}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
530 instead.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
531
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
532 @item M-?
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
533 @kindex M-? @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
534 @findex comint-dynamic-list-filename@dots{}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
535 Display temporarily a list of the possible completions of the file name
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
536 before point in the shell buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
537 (@code{comint-dynamic-list-filename-completions}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
538
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
539 @item C-d
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
540 @kindex C-d @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
541 @findex comint-delchar-or-maybe-eof
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52701
diff changeset
542 Either delete a character or send @acronym{EOF}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
543 (@code{comint-delchar-or-maybe-eof}). Typed at the end of the shell
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52701
diff changeset
544 buffer, @kbd{C-d} sends @acronym{EOF} to the subshell. Typed at any other
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
545 position in the buffer, @kbd{C-d} deletes a character as usual.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
546
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
547 @item C-c C-a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
548 @kindex C-c C-a @r{(Shell mode)}
37846
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
549 @findex comint-bol-or-process-mark
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
550 Move to the beginning of the line, but after the prompt if any
37846
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
551 (@code{comint-bol-or-process-mark}). If you repeat this command twice
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
552 in a row, the second time it moves back to the process mark, which is
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
553 the beginning of the input that you have not yet sent to the subshell.
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
554 (Normally that is the same place---the end of the prompt on this
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
555 line---but after @kbd{C-c @key{SPC}} the process mark may be in a
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
556 previous line.)
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
557
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
558 @item C-c @key{SPC}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
559 Accumulate multiple lines of input, then send them together. This
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
560 command inserts a newline before point, but does not send the preceding
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
561 text as input to the subshell---at least, not yet. Both lines, the one
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
562 before this newline and the one after, will be sent together (along with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
563 the newline that separates them), when you type @key{RET}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
564
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
565 @item C-c C-u
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
566 @kindex C-c C-u @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
567 @findex comint-kill-input
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
568 Kill all text pending at end of buffer to be sent as input
61880
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
569 (@code{comint-kill-input}). If point is not at end of buffer,
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
570 this only kills the part of this text that precedes point.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
571
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
572 @item C-c C-w
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
573 @kindex C-c C-w @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
574 Kill a word before point (@code{backward-kill-word}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
575
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
576 @item C-c C-c
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
577 @kindex C-c C-c @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
578 @findex comint-interrupt-subjob
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
579 Interrupt the shell or its current subjob if any
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
580 (@code{comint-interrupt-subjob}). This command also kills
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
581 any shell input pending in the shell buffer and not yet sent.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
582
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
583 @item C-c C-z
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
584 @kindex C-c C-z @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
585 @findex comint-stop-subjob
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
586 Stop the shell or its current subjob if any (@code{comint-stop-subjob}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
587 This command also kills any shell input pending in the shell buffer and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
588 not yet sent.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
589
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
590 @item C-c C-\
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
591 @findex comint-quit-subjob
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
592 @kindex C-c C-\ @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
593 Send quit signal to the shell or its current subjob if any
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
594 (@code{comint-quit-subjob}). This command also kills any shell input
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
595 pending in the shell buffer and not yet sent.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
596
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
597 @item C-c C-o
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
598 @kindex C-c C-o @r{(Shell mode)}
32637
6fcf803fe8c5 (Shell Mode):
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32516
diff changeset
599 @findex comint-delete-output
6fcf803fe8c5 (Shell Mode):
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32516
diff changeset
600 Delete the last batch of output from a shell command
6fcf803fe8c5 (Shell Mode):
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32516
diff changeset
601 (@code{comint-delete-output}). This is useful if a shell command spews
6fcf803fe8c5 (Shell Mode):
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32516
diff changeset
602 out lots of output that just gets in the way. This command used to be
6fcf803fe8c5 (Shell Mode):
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32516
diff changeset
603 called @code{comint-kill-output}.
6fcf803fe8c5 (Shell Mode):
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32516
diff changeset
604
6fcf803fe8c5 (Shell Mode):
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32516
diff changeset
605 @item C-c C-s
6fcf803fe8c5 (Shell Mode):
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32516
diff changeset
606 @kindex C-c C-s @r{(Shell mode)}
6fcf803fe8c5 (Shell Mode):
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32516
diff changeset
607 @findex comint-write-output
6fcf803fe8c5 (Shell Mode):
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32516
diff changeset
608 Write the last batch of output from a shell command to a file
6fcf803fe8c5 (Shell Mode):
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32516
diff changeset
609 (@code{comint-write-output}). With a prefix argument, the file is
6fcf803fe8c5 (Shell Mode):
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32516
diff changeset
610 appended to instead. Any prompt at the end of the output is not
6fcf803fe8c5 (Shell Mode):
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 32516
diff changeset
611 written.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
612
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
613 @item C-c C-r
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
614 @itemx C-M-l
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
615 @kindex C-c C-r @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
616 @kindex C-M-l @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
617 @findex comint-show-output
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
618 Scroll to display the beginning of the last batch of output at the top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
619 of the window; also move the cursor there (@code{comint-show-output}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
620
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
621 @item C-c C-e
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
622 @kindex C-c C-e @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
623 @findex comint-show-maximum-output
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
624 Scroll to put the end of the buffer at the bottom of the window
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
625 (@code{comint-show-maximum-output}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
626
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
627 @item C-c C-f
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
628 @kindex C-c C-f @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
629 @findex shell-forward-command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
630 @vindex shell-command-regexp
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
631 Move forward across one shell command, but not beyond the current line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
632 (@code{shell-forward-command}). The variable @code{shell-command-regexp}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
633 specifies how to recognize the end of a command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
634
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
635 @item C-c C-b
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
636 @kindex C-c C-b @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
637 @findex shell-backward-command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
638 Move backward across one shell command, but not beyond the current line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
639 (@code{shell-backward-command}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
640
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
641 @item M-x dirs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
642 Ask the shell what its current directory is, so that Emacs can agree
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
643 with the shell.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
644
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
645 @item M-x send-invisible @key{RET} @var{text} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
646 @findex send-invisible
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
647 Send @var{text} as input to the shell, after reading it without
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
648 echoing. This is useful when a shell command runs a program that asks
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
649 for a password.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
650
66708
24b48f5420b7 (Shell Mode): Describe how to activate password echoing.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 66098
diff changeset
651 Please note that Emacs will not echo passwords by default. If you
24b48f5420b7 (Shell Mode): Describe how to activate password echoing.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 66098
diff changeset
652 really want them to be echoed, evaluate the following Lisp
24b48f5420b7 (Shell Mode): Describe how to activate password echoing.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 66098
diff changeset
653 expression:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
654
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
655 @example
66708
24b48f5420b7 (Shell Mode): Describe how to activate password echoing.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 66098
diff changeset
656 (remove-hook 'comint-output-filter-functions
24b48f5420b7 (Shell Mode): Describe how to activate password echoing.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 66098
diff changeset
657 'comint-watch-for-password-prompt)
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
658 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
659
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
660 @item M-x comint-continue-subjob
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
661 @findex comint-continue-subjob
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
662 Continue the shell process. This is useful if you accidentally suspend
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
663 the shell process.@footnote{You should not suspend the shell process.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
664 Suspending a subjob of the shell is a completely different matter---that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
665 is normal practice, but you must use the shell to continue the subjob;
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
666 this command won't do it.}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
667
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
668 @item M-x comint-strip-ctrl-m
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
669 @findex comint-strip-ctrl-m
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
670 Discard all control-M characters from the current group of shell output.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
671 The most convenient way to use this command is to make it run
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
672 automatically when you get output from the subshell. To do that,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
673 evaluate this Lisp expression:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
674
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
675 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
676 (add-hook 'comint-output-filter-functions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
677 'comint-strip-ctrl-m)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
678 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
679
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
680 @item M-x comint-truncate-buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
681 @findex comint-truncate-buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
682 This command truncates the shell buffer to a certain maximum number of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
683 lines, specified by the variable @code{comint-buffer-maximum-size}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
684 Here's how to do this automatically each time you get output from the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
685 subshell:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
686
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
687 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
688 (add-hook 'comint-output-filter-functions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
689 'comint-truncate-buffer)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
690 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
691 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
692
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
693 @cindex Comint mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
694 @cindex mode, Comint
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
695 Shell mode is a derivative of Comint mode, a general-purpose mode for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
696 communicating with interactive subprocesses. Most of the features of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
697 Shell mode actually come from Comint mode, as you can see from the
32516
f89fc1421b53 Update references to shell prompts and comint-prompt-regexp, etc.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 31310
diff changeset
698 command names listed above. The special features of Shell mode include
f89fc1421b53 Update references to shell prompts and comint-prompt-regexp, etc.
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 31310
diff changeset
699 the directory tracking feature, and a few user commands.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
700
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
701 Other Emacs features that use variants of Comint mode include GUD
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
702 (@pxref{Debuggers}) and @kbd{M-x run-lisp} (@pxref{External Lisp}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
703
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
704 @findex comint-run
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
705 You can use @kbd{M-x comint-run} to execute any program of your choice
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
706 in a subprocess using unmodified Comint mode---without the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
707 specializations of Shell mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
708
61880
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
709 @node Shell Prompts
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
710 @subsection Shell Prompts
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
711
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
712 @vindex shell-prompt-pattern
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
713 @vindex comint-prompt-regexp
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
714 @vindex comint-use-prompt-regexp
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
715 @cindex prompt, shell
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
716 A prompt is text output by a program to show that it is ready to
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
717 accept new user input. Normally, Comint mode (and thus Shell mode)
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
718 considers the prompt to be any text output by a program at the
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
719 beginning of an input line. However, if the variable
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
720 @code{comint-use-prompt-regexp} is non-@code{nil}, then Comint mode
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
721 uses a regular expression to recognize prompts. In Shell mode,
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
722 @code{shell-prompt-pattern} specifies the regular expression.
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
723
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
724 The value of @code{comint-use-prompt-regexp} also affects many
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
725 motion and paragraph commands. If the value is non-@code{nil}, the
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
726 general Emacs motion commands behave as they normally do in buffers
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
727 without special text properties. However, if the value is @code{nil},
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
728 the default, then Comint mode divides the buffer into two types of
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
729 ``fields'' (ranges of consecutive characters having the same
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
730 @code{field} text property): input and output. Prompts are part of
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
731 the output. Most Emacs motion commands do not cross field boundaries,
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
732 unless they move over multiple lines. For instance, when point is in
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
733 input on the same line as a prompt, @kbd{C-a} puts point at the
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
734 beginning of the input if @code{comint-use-prompt-regexp} is
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
735 @code{nil} and at the beginning of the line otherwise.
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
736
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
737 In Shell mode, only shell prompts start new paragraphs. Thus, a
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
738 paragraph consists of a prompt and the input and output that follow
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
739 it. However, if @code{comint-use-prompt-regexp} is @code{nil}, the
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
740 default, most paragraph commands do not cross field boundaries. This
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
741 means that prompts, ranges of input, and ranges of non-prompt output
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
742 behave mostly like separate paragraphs; with this setting, numeric
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
743 arguments to most paragraph commands yield essentially undefined
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
744 behavior. For the purpose of finding paragraph boundaries, Shell mode
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
745 uses @code{shell-prompt-pattern}, regardless of
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
746 @code{comint-use-prompt-regexp}.
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
747
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
748 @node Shell History
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
749 @subsection Shell Command History
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
750
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
751 Shell buffers support three ways of repeating earlier commands. You
60432
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
752 can use keys like those used for the minibuffer history; these work
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
753 much as they do in the minibuffer, inserting text from prior commands
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
754 while point remains always at the end of the buffer. You can move
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
755 through the buffer to previous inputs in their original place, then
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
756 resubmit them or copy them to the end. Or you can use a
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
757 @samp{!}-style history reference.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
758
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
759 @menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
760 * Ring: Shell Ring. Fetching commands from the history list.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
761 * Copy: Shell History Copying. Moving to a command and then copying it.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
762 * History References:: Expanding @samp{!}-style history references.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
763 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
764
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
765 @node Shell Ring
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
766 @subsubsection Shell History Ring
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
767
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
768 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
769 @findex comint-previous-input
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
770 @kindex M-p @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
771 @item M-p
60432
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
772 @itemx C-@key{UP}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
773 Fetch the next earlier old shell command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
774
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
775 @kindex M-n @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
776 @findex comint-next-input
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
777 @item M-n
60432
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
778 @itemx C-@key{DOWN}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
779 Fetch the next later old shell command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
780
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
781 @kindex M-r @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
782 @kindex M-s @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
783 @findex comint-previous-matching-input
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
784 @findex comint-next-matching-input
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
785 @item M-r @var{regexp} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
786 @itemx M-s @var{regexp} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
787 Search backwards or forwards for old shell commands that match @var{regexp}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
788
56222
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
789 @item C-c C-x
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
790 @kindex C-c C-x @r{(Shell mode)}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
791 @findex comint-get-next-from-history
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
792 Fetch the next subsequent command from the history.
46244
c31280155efa Document C-c . in Shell mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43044
diff changeset
793
56222
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
794 @item C-c .
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
795 @kindex C-c . @r{(Shell mode)}
46244
c31280155efa Document C-c . in Shell mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43044
diff changeset
796 @findex comint-input-previous-argument
c31280155efa Document C-c . in Shell mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43044
diff changeset
797 Fetch one argument from an old shell command.
56222
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
798
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
799 @item C-c C-l
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
800 @kindex C-c C-l @r{(Shell mode)}
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
801 @findex comint-dynamic-list-input-ring
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
802 Display the buffer's history of shell commands in another window
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
803 (@code{comint-dynamic-list-input-ring}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
804 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
805
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
806 Shell buffers provide a history of previously entered shell commands. To
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
807 reuse shell commands from the history, use the editing commands @kbd{M-p},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
808 @kbd{M-n}, @kbd{M-r} and @kbd{M-s}. These work just like the minibuffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
809 history commands except that they operate on the text at the end of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
810 shell buffer, where you would normally insert text to send to the shell.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
811
60432
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
812 @kbd{M-p} fetches an earlier shell command to the end of the shell
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
813 buffer. Successive use of @kbd{M-p} fetches successively earlier
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
814 shell commands, each replacing any text that was already present as
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
815 potential shell input. @kbd{M-n} does likewise except that it finds
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
816 successively more recent shell commands from the buffer.
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
817 @kbd{C-@key{UP}} works like @kbd{M-p}, and @kbd{C-@key{DOWN}} like
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
818 @kbd{M-n}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
819
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
820 The history search commands @kbd{M-r} and @kbd{M-s} read a regular
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
821 expression and search through the history for a matching command. Aside
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
822 from the choice of which command to fetch, they work just like @kbd{M-p}
38740
5c0509ab3f20 Minor cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38599
diff changeset
823 and @kbd{M-n}. If you enter an empty regexp, these commands reuse the
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
824 same regexp used last time.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
825
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
826 When you find the previous input you want, you can resubmit it by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
827 typing @key{RET}, or you can edit it first and then resubmit it if you
70117
13078b41e1eb Added sentence on partial input being saved with M-p/M-n/M-s/M-r.
J.D. Smith <jdsmith@as.arizona.edu>
parents: 70080
diff changeset
828 wish. Any partial input you were composing before navigating the
13078b41e1eb Added sentence on partial input being saved with M-p/M-n/M-s/M-r.
J.D. Smith <jdsmith@as.arizona.edu>
parents: 70080
diff changeset
829 history list is restored when you go to the beginning or end of the
13078b41e1eb Added sentence on partial input being saved with M-p/M-n/M-s/M-r.
J.D. Smith <jdsmith@as.arizona.edu>
parents: 70080
diff changeset
830 history ring.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
831
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
832 Often it is useful to reexecute several successive shell commands that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
833 were previously executed in sequence. To do this, first find and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
834 reexecute the first command of the sequence. Then type @kbd{C-c C-x};
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
835 that will fetch the following command---the one that follows the command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
836 you just repeated. Then type @key{RET} to reexecute this command. You
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
837 can reexecute several successive commands by typing @kbd{C-c C-x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
838 @key{RET}} over and over.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
839
46244
c31280155efa Document C-c . in Shell mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43044
diff changeset
840 The command @kbd{C-c .}@: (@code{comint-input-previous-argument})
c31280155efa Document C-c . in Shell mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43044
diff changeset
841 copies an individual argument from a previous command, like @kbd{ESC
c31280155efa Document C-c . in Shell mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43044
diff changeset
842 .} in Bash. The simplest use copies the last argument from the
c31280155efa Document C-c . in Shell mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43044
diff changeset
843 previous shell command. With a prefix argument @var{n}, it copies the
c31280155efa Document C-c . in Shell mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43044
diff changeset
844 @var{n}th argument instead. Repeating @kbd{C-c .} copies from an
c31280155efa Document C-c . in Shell mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43044
diff changeset
845 earlier shell command instead, always using the same value of @var{n}
c31280155efa Document C-c . in Shell mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43044
diff changeset
846 (don't give a prefix argument when you repeat the @kbd{C-c .}
c31280155efa Document C-c . in Shell mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43044
diff changeset
847 command).
c31280155efa Document C-c . in Shell mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43044
diff changeset
848
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
849 These commands get the text of previous shell commands from a special
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
850 history list, not from the shell buffer itself. Thus, editing the shell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
851 buffer, or even killing large parts of it, does not affect the history
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
852 that these commands access.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
853
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
854 @vindex shell-input-ring-file-name
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
855 Some shells store their command histories in files so that you can
61880
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
856 refer to commands from previous shell sessions. Emacs reads
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
857 the command history file for your chosen shell, to initialize its own
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
858 command history. The file name is @file{~/.bash_history} for bash,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
859 @file{~/.sh_history} for ksh, and @file{~/.history} for other shells.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
860
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
861 @node Shell History Copying
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
862 @subsubsection Shell History Copying
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
863
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
864 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
865 @kindex C-c C-p @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
866 @findex comint-previous-prompt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
867 @item C-c C-p
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
868 Move point to the previous prompt (@code{comint-previous-prompt}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
869
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
870 @kindex C-c C-n @r{(Shell mode)}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
871 @findex comint-next-prompt
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
872 @item C-c C-n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
873 Move point to the following prompt (@code{comint-next-prompt}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
874
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
875 @kindex C-c RET @r{(Shell mode)}
56222
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
876 @findex comint-insert-input
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
877 @item C-c @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
878 Copy the input command which point is in, inserting the copy at the end
56222
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
879 of the buffer (@code{comint-insert-input}). This is useful if you
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
880 move point back to a previous command. After you copy the command, you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
881 can submit the copy as input with @key{RET}. If you wish, you can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
882 edit the copy before resubmitting it.
56222
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
883
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
884 @item Mouse-2
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
885 Copy the input command that you click on, inserting the copy at the end
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
886 of the buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
887 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
888
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
889 Moving to a previous input and then copying it with @kbd{C-c
56222
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
890 @key{RET}} or @kbd{Mouse-2} produces the same results---the same
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
891 buffer contents---that you would get by using @kbd{M-p} enough times
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
892 to fetch that previous input from the history list. However, @kbd{C-c
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
893 @key{RET}} copies the text from the buffer, which can be different
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
894 from what is in the history list if you edit the input text in the
136f1c16dc45 (Shell History Copying): Document comint-insert-input.
Nick Roberts <nickrob@snap.net.nz>
parents: 54475
diff changeset
895 buffer after it has been sent.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
896
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
897 @node History References
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
898 @subsubsection Shell History References
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
899 @cindex history reference
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
900
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
901 Various shells including csh and bash support @dfn{history
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
902 references} that begin with @samp{!} and @samp{^}. Shell mode
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
903 recognizes these constructs, and can perform the history substitution
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
904 for you.
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
905
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
906 If you insert a history reference and type @key{TAB}, this searches
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
907 the input history for a matching command, performs substitution if
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
908 necessary, and places the result in the buffer in place of the history
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
909 reference. For example, you can fetch the most recent command
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
910 beginning with @samp{mv} with @kbd{! m v @key{TAB}}. You can edit the
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
911 command if you wish, and then resubmit the command to the shell by
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
912 typing @key{RET}.
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
913
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
914 @vindex comint-input-autoexpand
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
915 @findex comint-magic-space
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
916 Shell mode can optionally expand history references in the buffer
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
917 when you send them to the shell. To request this, set the variable
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
918 @code{comint-input-autoexpand} to @code{input}. You can make
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
919 @key{SPC} perform history expansion by binding @key{SPC} to the
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
920 command @code{comint-magic-space}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
921
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
922 Shell mode recognizes history references when they follow a prompt.
61880
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
923 @xref{Shell Prompts}, for how Shell mode recognizes prompts.
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
924
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
925 @node Directory Tracking
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
926 @subsection Directory Tracking
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
927 @cindex directory tracking
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
928
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
929 @vindex shell-pushd-regexp
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
930 @vindex shell-popd-regexp
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
931 @vindex shell-cd-regexp
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
932 Shell mode keeps track of @samp{cd}, @samp{pushd} and @samp{popd}
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
933 commands given to the inferior shell, so it can keep the
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
934 @samp{*shell*} buffer's default directory the same as the shell's
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
935 working directory. It recognizes these commands syntactically, by
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
936 examining lines of input that are sent.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
937
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
938 If you use aliases for these commands, you can tell Emacs to
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
939 recognize them also. For example, if the value of the variable
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
940 @code{shell-pushd-regexp} matches the beginning of a shell command
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
941 line, that line is regarded as a @code{pushd} command. Change this
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
942 variable when you add aliases for @samp{pushd}. Likewise,
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
943 @code{shell-popd-regexp} and @code{shell-cd-regexp} are used to
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
944 recognize commands with the meaning of @samp{popd} and @samp{cd}.
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
945 These commands are recognized only at the beginning of a shell command
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
946 line.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
947
37846
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
948 @ignore @c This seems to have been deleted long ago.
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
949 @vindex shell-set-directory-error-hook
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
950 If Emacs gets an error while trying to handle what it believes is a
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
951 @samp{cd}, @samp{pushd} or @samp{popd} command, it runs the hook
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
952 @code{shell-set-directory-error-hook} (@pxref{Hooks}).
37846
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
953 @end ignore
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
954
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
955 @findex dirs
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
956 If Emacs gets confused about changes in the current directory of the
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
957 subshell, use the command @kbd{M-x dirs} to ask the shell what its
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
958 current directory is. This command works for shells that support the
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
959 most common command syntax; it may not work for unusual shells.
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
960
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
961 @findex dirtrack-mode
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
962 You can also use @kbd{M-x dirtrack-mode} to enable (or disable) an
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
963 alternative and more aggressive method of tracking changes in the
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
964 current directory.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
965
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
966 @node Shell Options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
967 @subsection Shell Mode Options
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
968
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
969 @vindex comint-scroll-to-bottom-on-input
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
970 If the variable @code{comint-scroll-to-bottom-on-input} is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
971 non-@code{nil}, insertion and yank commands scroll the selected window
70080
e7bda2fbb250 * misc.texi (Shell Options): Correct default value of
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents: 69797
diff changeset
972 to the bottom before inserting. The default is @code{nil}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
973
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
974 @vindex comint-scroll-show-maximum-output
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
975 If @code{comint-scroll-show-maximum-output} is non-@code{nil}, then
51450
676ec3dcee9d (Shell Options): Clarify comint-scroll-show-maximum-output.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 49600
diff changeset
976 arrival of output when point is at the end tries to place the last line of
38599
29e540f10e62 Proofreading changes from JDonner <jdonner0@earthlink.net>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38467
diff changeset
977 text at the bottom line of the window, so as to show as much useful
70080
e7bda2fbb250 * misc.texi (Shell Options): Correct default value of
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents: 69797
diff changeset
978 text as possible. (This mimics the scrolling behavior of most
e7bda2fbb250 * misc.texi (Shell Options): Correct default value of
Chong Yidong <cyd@stupidchicken.com>
parents: 69797
diff changeset
979 terminals.) The default is @code{t}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
980
51450
676ec3dcee9d (Shell Options): Clarify comint-scroll-show-maximum-output.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 49600
diff changeset
981 @vindex comint-move-point-for-output
676ec3dcee9d (Shell Options): Clarify comint-scroll-show-maximum-output.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 49600
diff changeset
982 By setting @code{comint-move-point-for-output}, you can opt for
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
983 having point jump to the end of the buffer whenever output arrives---no
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
984 matter where in the buffer point was before. If the value is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
985 @code{this}, point jumps in the selected window. If the value is
38599
29e540f10e62 Proofreading changes from JDonner <jdonner0@earthlink.net>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38467
diff changeset
986 @code{all}, point jumps in each window that shows the Comint buffer. If
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
987 the value is @code{other}, point jumps in all nonselected windows that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
988 show the current buffer. The default value is @code{nil}, which means
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
989 point does not jump to the end.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
990
60432
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
991 @vindex comint-prompt-read-only
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
992 If you set @code{comint-prompt-read-only}, the prompts in the Comint
60496
3a569489ffdb (Single Shell, Shell Options): Fix previous change.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60467
diff changeset
993 buffer are read-only.
60432
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
994
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
995 @vindex comint-input-ignoredups
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
996 The variable @code{comint-input-ignoredups} controls whether successive
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
997 identical inputs are stored in the input history. A non-@code{nil}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
998 value means to omit an input that is the same as the previous input.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
999 The default is @code{nil}, which means to store each input even if it is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1000 equal to the previous input.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1001
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1002 @vindex comint-completion-addsuffix
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1003 @vindex comint-completion-recexact
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1004 @vindex comint-completion-autolist
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1005 Three variables customize file name completion. The variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1006 @code{comint-completion-addsuffix} controls whether completion inserts a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1007 space or a slash to indicate a fully completed file or directory name
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1008 (non-@code{nil} means do insert a space or slash).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1009 @code{comint-completion-recexact}, if non-@code{nil}, directs @key{TAB}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1010 to choose the shortest possible completion if the usual Emacs completion
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1011 algorithm cannot add even a single character.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1012 @code{comint-completion-autolist}, if non-@code{nil}, says to list all
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1013 the possible completions whenever completion is not exact.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1014
37846
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
1015 @vindex shell-completion-execonly
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1016 Command completion normally considers only executable files.
37846
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
1017 If you set @code{shell-completion-execonly} to @code{nil},
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1018 it considers nonexecutable files as well.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1019
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1020 @findex shell-pushd-tohome
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1021 @findex shell-pushd-dextract
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1022 @findex shell-pushd-dunique
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1023 You can configure the behavior of @samp{pushd}. Variables control
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1024 whether @samp{pushd} behaves like @samp{cd} if no argument is given
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1025 (@code{shell-pushd-tohome}), pop rather than rotate with a numeric
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1026 argument (@code{shell-pushd-dextract}), and only add directories to the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1027 directory stack if they are not already on it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1028 (@code{shell-pushd-dunique}). The values you choose should match the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1029 underlying shell, of course.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1030
40930
60252111f80c (Shell Options): Add brief mention of ansi-color.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39263
diff changeset
1031 If you want Shell mode to handle color output from shell commands,
60252111f80c (Shell Options): Add brief mention of ansi-color.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39263
diff changeset
1032 you can enable ANSI Color mode. Here is how to do this:
60252111f80c (Shell Options): Add brief mention of ansi-color.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39263
diff changeset
1033
60252111f80c (Shell Options): Add brief mention of ansi-color.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39263
diff changeset
1034 @example
60252111f80c (Shell Options): Add brief mention of ansi-color.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39263
diff changeset
1035 (add-hook 'shell-mode-hook 'ansi-color-for-comint-mode-on)
60252111f80c (Shell Options): Add brief mention of ansi-color.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39263
diff changeset
1036 @end example
60252111f80c (Shell Options): Add brief mention of ansi-color.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39263
diff changeset
1037
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1038 @node Terminal emulator
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1039 @subsection Emacs Terminal Emulator
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1040 @findex term
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1041
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1042 To run a subshell in a terminal emulator, putting its typescript in
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1043 an Emacs buffer, use @kbd{M-x term}. This creates (or reuses) a
37846
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
1044 buffer named @samp{*terminal*}, and runs a subshell with input coming
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
1045 from your keyboard, and output going to that buffer.
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1046
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1047 The terminal emulator uses Term mode, which has two input modes. In
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1048 line mode, Term basically acts like Shell mode; see @ref{Shell Mode}.
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1049
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1050 In char mode, each character is sent directly to the inferior
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1051 subshell, as ``terminal input.'' Any ``echoing'' of your input is the
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1052 responsibility of the subshell. The sole exception is the terminal
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1053 escape character, which by default is @kbd{C-c} (@pxref{Term Mode}).
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1054 Any ``terminal output'' from the subshell goes into the buffer,
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1055 advancing point.
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1056
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1057 Some programs (such as Emacs itself) need to control the appearance
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1058 on the terminal screen in detail. They do this by sending special
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1059 control codes. The exact control codes needed vary from terminal to
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1060 terminal, but nowadays most terminals and terminal emulators
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1061 (including @code{xterm}) understand the ANSI-standard (VT100-style)
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1062 escape sequences. Term mode recognizes these escape sequences, and
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1063 handles each one appropriately, changing the buffer so that the
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1064 appearance of the window matches what it would be on a real terminal.
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1065 You can actually run Emacs inside an Emacs Term window.
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1066
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1067 The file name used to load the subshell is determined the same way
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1068 as for Shell mode. To make multiple terminal emulators, rename the
37846
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
1069 buffer @samp{*terminal*} to something different using @kbd{M-x
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1070 rename-uniquely}, just as with Shell mode.
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1071
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1072 Unlike Shell mode, Term mode does not track the current directory by
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1073 examining your input. But some shells can tell Term what the current
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1074 directory is. This is done automatically by @code{bash} version 1.15
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1075 and later.
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1076
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1077 @node Term Mode
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1078 @subsection Term Mode
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1079 @cindex Term mode
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1080 @cindex mode, Term
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1081
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1082 The terminal emulator uses Term mode, which has two input modes. In
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1083 line mode, Term basically acts like Shell mode; see @ref{Shell Mode}.
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1084 In char mode, each character is sent directly to the inferior
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1085 subshell, except for the Term escape character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1086
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1087 To switch between line and char mode, use these commands:
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1088
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1089 @table @kbd
46244
c31280155efa Document C-c . in Shell mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43044
diff changeset
1090 @kindex C-c C-j @r{(Term mode)}
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1091 @findex term-char-mode
46244
c31280155efa Document C-c . in Shell mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43044
diff changeset
1092 @item C-c C-j
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1093 Switch to line mode. Do nothing if already in line mode.
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1094
46244
c31280155efa Document C-c . in Shell mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43044
diff changeset
1095 @kindex C-c C-k @r{(Term mode)}
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1096 @findex term-line-mode
46244
c31280155efa Document C-c . in Shell mode.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 43044
diff changeset
1097 @item C-c C-k
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1098 Switch to char mode. Do nothing if already in char mode.
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1099 @end table
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1100
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1101 The following commands are only available in char mode:
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1102
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1103 @table @kbd
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1104 @item C-c C-c
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1105 Send a literal @key{C-c} to the sub-shell.
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1106
58765
9a73265ddd16 (Term Mode): Correcty describe C-c.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56807
diff changeset
1107 @item C-c @var{char}
9a73265ddd16 (Term Mode): Correcty describe C-c.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56807
diff changeset
1108 This is equivalent to @kbd{C-x @var{char}} in normal Emacs. For
9a73265ddd16 (Term Mode): Correcty describe C-c.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56807
diff changeset
1109 example, @kbd{C-c o} invokes the global binding of @kbd{C-x o}, which
9a73265ddd16 (Term Mode): Correcty describe C-c.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 56807
diff changeset
1110 is normally @samp{other-window}.
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1111 @end table
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1112
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1113 @node Paging in Term
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1114 @subsection Page-At-A-Time Output
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1115 @cindex page-at-a-time
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1116
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1117 Term mode has a page-at-a-time feature. When enabled it makes
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1118 output pause at the end of each screenful.
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1119
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1120 @table @kbd
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1121 @kindex C-c C-q @r{(Term mode)}
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1122 @findex term-pager-toggle
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1123 @item C-c C-q
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1124 Toggle the page-at-a-time feature. This command works in both line
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1125 and char modes. When page-at-a-time is enabled, the mode-line
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1126 displays the word @samp{page}.
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1127 @end table
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1128
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1129 With page-at-a-time enabled, whenever Term receives more than a
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1130 screenful of output since your last input, it pauses, displaying
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1131 @samp{**MORE**} in the mode-line. Type @key{SPC} to display the next
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1132 screenful of output. Type @kbd{?} to see your other options. The
38865
62e02f5ae533 Avoid saying "Unix" in a way that includes GNU.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38786
diff changeset
1133 interface is similar to the @code{more} program.
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1134
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1135 @node Remote Host
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1136 @subsection Remote Host Shell
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1137 @cindex remote host
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1138 @cindex connecting to remote host
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1139 @cindex Telnet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1140 @cindex Rlogin
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1141
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1142 You can login to a remote computer, using whatever commands you
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1143 would from a regular terminal (e.g.@: using the @code{telnet} or
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1144 @code{rlogin} commands), from a Term window.
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1145
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1146 A program that asks you for a password will normally suppress
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1147 echoing of the password, so the password will not show up in the
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1148 buffer. This will happen just as if you were using a real terminal,
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1149 if the buffer is in char mode. If it is in line mode, the password is
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1150 temporarily visible, but will be erased when you hit return. (This
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1151 happens automatically; there is no special password processing.)
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1152
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1153 When you log in to a different machine, you need to specify the type
61880
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
1154 of terminal you're using, by setting the @env{TERM} environment
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
1155 variable in the environment for the remote login command. (If you use
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
1156 bash, you do that by writing the variable assignment before the remote
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
1157 login command, without separating comma.) Terminal types @samp{ansi}
661ef1edb844 (Shell): Add `Shell Prompts' to menu.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 61639
diff changeset
1158 or @samp{vt100} will work on most systems.
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1159
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1160 @c If you are talking to a Bourne-compatible
29107
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29083
diff changeset
1161 @c shell, and your system understands the @env{TERMCAP} variable,
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1162 @c you can use the command @kbd{M-x shell-send-termcap}, which
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1163 @c sends a string specifying the terminal type and size.
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1164 @c (This command is also useful after the window has changed size.)
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1165
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1166 @c You can of course run @samp{gdb} on that remote computer. One useful
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1167 @c trick: If you invoke gdb with the @code{--fullname} option,
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1168 @c it will send special commands to Emacs that will cause Emacs to
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1169 @c pop up the source files you're debugging. This will work
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1170 @c whether or not gdb is running on a different computer than Emacs,
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1171 @c as long as Emacs can access the source files specified by gdb.
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1172
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1173 @ignore
38599
29e540f10e62 Proofreading changes from JDonner <jdonner0@earthlink.net>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38467
diff changeset
1174 You cannot log in to a remote computer using the Shell mode.
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1175 @c (This will change when Shell is re-written to use Term.)
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1176 Instead, Emacs provides two commands for logging in to another computer
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1177 and communicating with it through an Emacs buffer using Comint mode:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1178
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1179 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1180 @item M-x telnet @key{RET} @var{hostname} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1181 Set up a Telnet connection to the computer named @var{hostname}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1182 @item M-x rlogin @key{RET} @var{hostname} @key{RET}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1183 Set up an Rlogin connection to the computer named @var{hostname}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1184 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1185
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1186 @findex telnet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1187 Use @kbd{M-x telnet} to set up a Telnet connection to another
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1188 computer. (Telnet is the standard Internet protocol for remote login.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1189 It reads the host name of the other computer as an argument with the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1190 minibuffer. Once the connection is established, talking to the other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1191 computer works like talking to a subshell: you can edit input with the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1192 usual Emacs commands, and send it a line at a time by typing @key{RET}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1193 The output is inserted in the Telnet buffer interspersed with the input.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1194
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1195 @findex rlogin
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1196 @vindex rlogin-explicit-args
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1197 Use @kbd{M-x rlogin} to set up an Rlogin connection. Rlogin is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1198 another remote login communication protocol, essentially much like the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1199 Telnet protocol but incompatible with it, and supported only by certain
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1200 systems. Rlogin's advantages are that you can arrange not to have to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1201 give your user name and password when communicating between two machines
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1202 you frequently use, and that you can make an 8-bit-clean connection.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1203 (To do that in Emacs, set @code{rlogin-explicit-args} to @code{("-8")}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1204 before you run Rlogin.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1205
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1206 @kbd{M-x rlogin} sets up the default file directory of the Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1207 buffer to access the remote host via FTP (@pxref{File Names}), and it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1208 tracks the shell commands that change the current directory, just like
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1209 Shell mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1210
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1211 @findex rlogin-directory-tracking-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1212 There are two ways of doing directory tracking in an Rlogin
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1213 buffer---either with remote directory names
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1214 @file{/@var{host}:@var{dir}/} or with local names (that works if the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1215 ``remote'' machine shares file systems with your machine of origin).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1216 You can use the command @code{rlogin-directory-tracking-mode} to switch
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1217 modes. No argument means use remote directory names, a positive
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1218 argument means use local names, and a negative argument means turn
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1219 off directory tracking.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1220
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1221 @end ignore
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1222
63004
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1223 @node Emacs Server, Printing, Shell, Top
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1224 @section Using Emacs as a Server
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1225 @pindex emacsclient
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1226 @cindex Emacs as a server
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1227 @cindex server, using Emacs as
29107
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29083
diff changeset
1228 @cindex @env{EDITOR} environment variable
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1229
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1230 Various programs such as @code{mail} can invoke your choice of editor
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1231 to edit a particular piece of text, such as a message that you are
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1232 sending. By convention, most of these programs use the environment
29107
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29083
diff changeset
1233 variable @env{EDITOR} to specify which editor to run. If you set
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29083
diff changeset
1234 @env{EDITOR} to @samp{emacs}, they invoke Emacs---but in an
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1235 inconvenient fashion, by starting a new, separate Emacs process. This
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1236 is inconvenient because it takes time and because the new Emacs process
38599
29e540f10e62 Proofreading changes from JDonner <jdonner0@earthlink.net>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38467
diff changeset
1237 doesn't share the buffers in any existing Emacs process.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1238
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1239 You can arrange to use your existing Emacs process as the editor for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1240 programs like @code{mail} by using the Emacs client and Emacs server
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1241 programs. Here is how.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1242
29107
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29083
diff changeset
1243 @cindex @env{TEXEDIT} environment variable
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1244 First, the preparation. Within Emacs, call the function
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1245 @code{server-start}. (Your @file{.emacs} file can do this automatically
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1246 if you add the expression @code{(server-start)} to it.) Then, outside
29107
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29083
diff changeset
1247 Emacs, set the @env{EDITOR} environment variable to @samp{emacsclient}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1248 (Note that some programs use a different environment variable; for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1249 example, to make @TeX{} use @samp{emacsclient}, you should set the
29107
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29083
diff changeset
1250 @env{TEXEDIT} environment variable to @samp{emacsclient +%d %s}.)
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1251
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1252 @kindex C-x #
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1253 @findex server-edit
29107
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29083
diff changeset
1254 Then, whenever any program invokes your specified @env{EDITOR}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1255 program, the effect is to send a message to your principal Emacs telling
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1256 it to visit a file. (That's what the program @code{emacsclient} does.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1257 Emacs displays the buffer immediately and you can immediately begin
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1258 editing it.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1259
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1260 When you've finished editing that buffer, type @kbd{C-x #}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1261 (@code{server-edit}). This saves the file and sends a message back to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1262 the @code{emacsclient} program telling it to exit. The programs that
29107
203ba1f77b7b *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 29083
diff changeset
1263 use @env{EDITOR} wait for the ``editor'' (actually, @code{emacsclient})
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1264 to exit. @kbd{C-x #} also checks for other pending external requests
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1265 to edit various files, and selects the next such file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1266
37846
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
1267 You can switch to a server buffer manually if you wish; you don't
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
1268 have to arrive at it with @kbd{C-x #}. But @kbd{C-x #} is the way to
38599
29e540f10e62 Proofreading changes from JDonner <jdonner0@earthlink.net>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38467
diff changeset
1269 say that you are finished with one.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1270
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1271 @vindex server-kill-new-buffers
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1272 @vindex server-temp-file-regexp
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1273 Finishing with a server buffer also kills the buffer, unless it
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1274 already existed in the Emacs session before the server asked to create
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1275 it. However, if you set @code{server-kill-new-buffers} to @code{nil},
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1276 then a different criterion is used: finishing with a server buffer
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1277 kills it if the file name matches the regular expression
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1278 @code{server-temp-file-regexp}. This is set up to distinguish certain
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1279 ``temporary'' files.
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1280
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1281 @vindex server-window
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1282 If you set the variable @code{server-window} to a window or a frame,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1283 @kbd{C-x #} displays the server buffer in that window or in that frame.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1284
60954
276ede258da1 (Emacs Server): Document server-name.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60799
diff changeset
1285 @vindex server-name
276ede258da1 (Emacs Server): Document server-name.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60799
diff changeset
1286 You can run multiple Emacs servers on the same machine by giving
276ede258da1 (Emacs Server): Document server-name.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60799
diff changeset
1287 each one a unique ``server name'', using the variable
61102
7c6643312d7d (Emacs Server): Fix Texinfo usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 61007
diff changeset
1288 @code{server-name}. For example, @kbd{M-x set-variable @key{RET}
7c6643312d7d (Emacs Server): Fix Texinfo usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 61007
diff changeset
1289 server-name @key{RET} foo @key{RET}} sets the server name to
7c6643312d7d (Emacs Server): Fix Texinfo usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 61007
diff changeset
1290 @samp{foo}. The @code{emacsclient} program can visit a server by name
7c6643312d7d (Emacs Server): Fix Texinfo usage.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 61007
diff changeset
1291 using the @samp{-s} option. @xref{Invoking emacsclient}.
60954
276ede258da1 (Emacs Server): Document server-name.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60799
diff changeset
1292
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1293 While @code{mail} or another application is waiting for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1294 @code{emacsclient} to finish, @code{emacsclient} does not read terminal
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1295 input. So the terminal that @code{mail} was using is effectively
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1296 blocked for the duration. In order to edit with your principal Emacs,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1297 you need to be able to use it without using that terminal. There are
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1298 three ways to do this:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1299
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1300 @itemize @bullet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1301 @item
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1302 Using a window system, run @code{mail} and the principal Emacs in two
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1303 separate windows. While @code{mail} is waiting for @code{emacsclient},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1304 the window where it was running is blocked, but you can use Emacs by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1305 switching windows.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1306
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1307 @item
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1308 Using virtual terminals, run @code{mail} in one virtual terminal
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1309 and run Emacs in another.
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1310
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1311 @item
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1312 Use Shell mode or Term mode in Emacs to run the other program such as
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1313 @code{mail}; then, @code{emacsclient} blocks only the subshell under
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1314 Emacs, and you can still use Emacs to edit the file.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1315 @end itemize
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1316
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1317 If you run @code{emacsclient} with the option @samp{--no-wait}, it
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1318 returns immediately without waiting for you to ``finish'' the buffer
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1319 in Emacs. Note that server buffers created in this way are not killed
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1320 automatically when you finish with them.
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
1321
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1322 @menu
62473
ee50af163f00 (Emacs Server): Add menu description.
Lute Kamstra <lute@gnu.org>
parents: 61880
diff changeset
1323 * Invoking emacsclient:: Emacs client startup options.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1324 @end menu
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1325
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1326 @node Invoking emacsclient,, Emacs Server, Emacs Server
56807
d2c0e48f4d5a Adapt sectioning in Info to the node structure.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 56222
diff changeset
1327 @subsection Invoking @code{emacsclient}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1328
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1329 To run the @code{emacsclient} program, specify file names as arguments,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1330 and optionally line numbers as well. Do it like this:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1331
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1332 @example
38467
7f472a1b6c80 Add description of +LINE:COLUMN for emacsclient.
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 38459
diff changeset
1333 emacsclient @r{@{}@r{[}+@var{line}@r{[}@var{column}@r{]}@r{]} @var{filename}@r{@}}@dots{}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1334 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1335
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1336 @noindent
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1337 This tells Emacs to visit each of the specified files; if you specify a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1338 line number for a certain file, Emacs moves to that line in the file.
38786
4d3fd773cd30 Minor cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38740
diff changeset
1339 If you specify a column number as well, Emacs puts point on that column
4d3fd773cd30 Minor cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38740
diff changeset
1340 in the line.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1341
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1342 Ordinarily, @code{emacsclient} does not return until you use the
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1343 @kbd{C-x #} command on each of these buffers. When that happens,
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1344 Emacs sends a message to the @code{emacsclient} program telling it to
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1345 return.
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1346
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1347 But if you use the option @samp{-n} or @samp{--no-wait} when running
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1348 @code{emacsclient}, then it returns immediately. (You can take as
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1349 long as you like to edit the files in Emacs.)
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1350
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1351 The option @samp{--alternate-editor=@var{command}} is useful when
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1352 running @code{emacsclient} in a script. It specifies a command to run
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1353 if @code{emacsclient} fails to contact Emacs. For example, the
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1354 following setting for the @var{EDITOR} environment variable will
60432
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
1355 always give you an editor, even if no Emacs server is running:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1356
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1357 @example
60432
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
1358 EDITOR="emacsclient --alternate-editor emacs +%d %s"
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1359 @end example
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1360
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1361 @noindent
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1362 The environment variable @var{ALTERNATE_EDITOR} has the same effect, but
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1363 the value of the @samp{--alternate-editor} takes precedence.
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1364
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1365 @pindex emacs.bash
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1366 Alternatively, the file @file{etc/emacs.bash} defines a bash
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1367 function which will communicate with a running Emacs server, or start
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1368 one if none exists.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1369
47650
5dbc6d83f14d Add info about --eval and --display.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 46244
diff changeset
1370 If you use several displays, you can tell Emacs on which display to
5dbc6d83f14d Add info about --eval and --display.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 46244
diff changeset
1371 open the given files with the option @samp{--display=@var{DISPLAY}}.
5dbc6d83f14d Add info about --eval and --display.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 46244
diff changeset
1372 This can be used typically when connecting from home to an Emacs
5dbc6d83f14d Add info about --eval and --display.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 46244
diff changeset
1373 server running on your machine at your workplace.
5dbc6d83f14d Add info about --eval and --display.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 46244
diff changeset
1374
60954
276ede258da1 (Emacs Server): Document server-name.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60799
diff changeset
1375 If there is more than one Emacs server running, you can specify a
276ede258da1 (Emacs Server): Document server-name.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60799
diff changeset
1376 server name with the option @samp{-s @var{name}}.
276ede258da1 (Emacs Server): Document server-name.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60799
diff changeset
1377
47650
5dbc6d83f14d Add info about --eval and --display.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 46244
diff changeset
1378 You can also use @code{emacsclient} to execute any piece of Emacs Lisp
5dbc6d83f14d Add info about --eval and --display.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 46244
diff changeset
1379 code, using the option @samp{--eval}. When this option is given, the
5dbc6d83f14d Add info about --eval and --display.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 46244
diff changeset
1380 rest of the arguments is not taken as a list of files to visit but as
5dbc6d83f14d Add info about --eval and --display.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 46244
diff changeset
1381 a list of expressions to evaluate.
5dbc6d83f14d Add info about --eval and --display.
Stefan Monnier <monnier@iro.umontreal.ca>
parents: 46244
diff changeset
1382
63004
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1383 @node Printing, Sorting, Emacs Server, Top
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1384 @section Printing Hard Copies
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1385 @cindex hardcopy
63004
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1386 @cindex printing
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1387
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1388 Emacs provides commands for printing hard copies of either an entire
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1389 buffer or just part of one, with or without page headers. You can
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1390 invoke the printing commands directly, as detailed in the following
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1391 section, or using the @samp{File} menu on the menu bar. See also the
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1392 hardcopy commands of Dired (@pxref{Misc File Ops}) and the diary
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1393 (@pxref{Displaying the Diary}).
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1394
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1395 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1396 @item M-x print-buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1397 Print hardcopy of current buffer with page headings containing the file
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1398 name and page number.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1399 @item M-x lpr-buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1400 Print hardcopy of current buffer without page headings.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1401 @item M-x print-region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1402 Like @code{print-buffer} but print only the current region.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1403 @item M-x lpr-region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1404 Like @code{lpr-buffer} but print only the current region.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1405 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1406
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1407 @findex print-buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1408 @findex print-region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1409 @findex lpr-buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1410 @findex lpr-region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1411 @vindex lpr-switches
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1412 The hardcopy commands (aside from the Postscript commands) pass extra
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1413 switches to the @code{lpr} program based on the value of the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1414 @code{lpr-switches}. Its value should be a list of strings, each string
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1415 an option starting with @samp{-}. For example, to specify a line width
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1416 of 80 columns for all the printing you do in Emacs, set
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1417 @code{lpr-switches} like this:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1418
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1419 @example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1420 (setq lpr-switches '("-w80"))
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1421 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1422
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1423 @vindex printer-name
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1424 You can specify the printer to use by setting the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1425 @code{printer-name}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1426
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1427 @vindex lpr-headers-switches
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1428 @vindex lpr-commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1429 @vindex lpr-add-switches
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1430 The variable @code{lpr-command} specifies the name of the printer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1431 program to run; the default value depends on your operating system type.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1432 On most systems, the default is @code{"lpr"}. The variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1433 @code{lpr-headers-switches} similarly specifies the extra switches to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1434 use to make page headers. The variable @code{lpr-add-switches} controls
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1435 whether to supply @samp{-T} and @samp{-J} options (suitable for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1436 @code{lpr}) to the printer program: @code{nil} means don't add them.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1437 @code{lpr-add-switches} should be @code{nil} if your printer program is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1438 not compatible with @code{lpr}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1439
63004
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1440 @menu
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1441 * PostScript:: Printing buffers or regions as PostScript.
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1442 * PostScript Variables:: Customizing the PostScript printing commands.
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1443 * Printing Package:: An optional advanced printing interface.
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1444 @end menu
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1445
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1446 @node PostScript, PostScript Variables,, Printing
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1447 @section PostScript Hardcopy
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1448
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1449 These commands convert buffer contents to PostScript,
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1450 either printing it or leaving it in another Emacs buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1451
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1452 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1453 @item M-x ps-print-buffer
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1454 Print hardcopy of the current buffer in PostScript form.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1455 @item M-x ps-print-region
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1456 Print hardcopy of the current region in PostScript form.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1457 @item M-x ps-print-buffer-with-faces
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1458 Print hardcopy of the current buffer in PostScript form, showing the
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1459 faces used in the text by means of PostScript features.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1460 @item M-x ps-print-region-with-faces
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1461 Print hardcopy of the current region in PostScript form, showing the
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1462 faces used in the text.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1463 @item M-x ps-spool-buffer
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1464 Generate PostScript for the current buffer text.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1465 @item M-x ps-spool-region
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1466 Generate PostScript for the current region.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1467 @item M-x ps-spool-buffer-with-faces
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1468 Generate PostScript for the current buffer, showing the faces used.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1469 @item M-x ps-spool-region-with-faces
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1470 Generate PostScript for the current region, showing the faces used.
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1471 @item M-x handwrite
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1472 Generates/prints PostScript for the current buffer as if handwritten.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1473 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1474
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1475 @findex ps-print-region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1476 @findex ps-print-buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1477 @findex ps-print-region-with-faces
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1478 @findex ps-print-buffer-with-faces
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1479 The PostScript commands, @code{ps-print-buffer} and
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1480 @code{ps-print-region}, print buffer contents in PostScript form. One
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1481 command prints the entire buffer; the other, just the region. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1482 corresponding @samp{-with-faces} commands,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1483 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} and @code{ps-print-region-with-faces},
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1484 use PostScript features to show the faces (fonts and colors) in the text
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1485 properties of the text being printed.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1486
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1487 If you are using a color display, you can print a buffer of program
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1488 code with color highlighting by turning on Font-Lock mode in that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1489 buffer, and using @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1490
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1491 @findex ps-spool-region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1492 @findex ps-spool-buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1493 @findex ps-spool-region-with-faces
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1494 @findex ps-spool-buffer-with-faces
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1495 The commands whose names have @samp{spool} instead of @samp{print}
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1496 generate the PostScript output in an Emacs buffer instead of sending
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1497 it to the printer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1498
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1499 @findex handwrite
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1500 @cindex handwriting
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1501 @kbd{M-x handwrite} is more frivolous. It generates a PostScript
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1502 rendition of the current buffer as a cursive handwritten document. It
37846
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
1503 can be customized in group @code{handwrite}. This function only
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
1504 supports ISO 8859-1 characters.
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1505
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1506 @ifinfo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1507 The following section describes variables for customizing these commands.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1508 @end ifinfo
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1509
63004
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1510 @node PostScript Variables, Printing Package, PostScript, Printing
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1511 @section Variables for PostScript Hardcopy
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1512
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1513 @vindex ps-lpr-command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1514 @vindex ps-lpr-switches
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1515 @vindex ps-printer-name
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
1516 All the PostScript hardcopy commands use the variables
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1517 @code{ps-lpr-command} and @code{ps-lpr-switches} to specify how to print
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1518 the output. @code{ps-lpr-command} specifies the command name to run,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1519 @code{ps-lpr-switches} specifies command line options to use, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1520 @code{ps-printer-name} specifies the printer. If you don't set the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1521 first two variables yourself, they take their initial values from
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1522 @code{lpr-command} and @code{lpr-switches}. If @code{ps-printer-name}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1523 is @code{nil}, @code{printer-name} is used.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1524
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1525 @vindex ps-print-header
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1526 The variable @code{ps-print-header} controls whether these commands
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1527 add header lines to each page---set it to @code{nil} to turn headers
35648
fd06a4e20d87 (PostScript Variables): Extend the documentation of ps-print-color-p.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 33382
diff changeset
1528 off.
fd06a4e20d87 (PostScript Variables): Extend the documentation of ps-print-color-p.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 33382
diff changeset
1529
fd06a4e20d87 (PostScript Variables): Extend the documentation of ps-print-color-p.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 33382
diff changeset
1530 @cindex color emulation on black-and-white printers
fd06a4e20d87 (PostScript Variables): Extend the documentation of ps-print-color-p.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 33382
diff changeset
1531 @vindex ps-print-color-p
fd06a4e20d87 (PostScript Variables): Extend the documentation of ps-print-color-p.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 33382
diff changeset
1532 If your printer doesn't support colors, you should turn off color
fd06a4e20d87 (PostScript Variables): Extend the documentation of ps-print-color-p.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 33382
diff changeset
1533 processing by setting @code{ps-print-color-p} to @code{nil}. By
fd06a4e20d87 (PostScript Variables): Extend the documentation of ps-print-color-p.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 33382
diff changeset
1534 default, if the display supports colors, Emacs produces hardcopy output
fd06a4e20d87 (PostScript Variables): Extend the documentation of ps-print-color-p.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 33382
diff changeset
1535 with color information; on black-and-white printers, colors are emulated
fd06a4e20d87 (PostScript Variables): Extend the documentation of ps-print-color-p.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 33382
diff changeset
1536 with shades of gray. This might produce illegible output, even if your
fd06a4e20d87 (PostScript Variables): Extend the documentation of ps-print-color-p.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 33382
diff changeset
1537 screen colors only use shades of gray.
fd06a4e20d87 (PostScript Variables): Extend the documentation of ps-print-color-p.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 33382
diff changeset
1538
fd06a4e20d87 (PostScript Variables): Extend the documentation of ps-print-color-p.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 33382
diff changeset
1539 @vindex ps-use-face-background
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1540 By default, PostScript printing ignores the background colors of the
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1541 faces, unless the variable @code{ps-use-face-background} is
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1542 non-@code{nil}. This is to avoid unwanted interference with the zebra
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
1543 stripes and background image/text.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1544
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1545 @vindex ps-paper-type
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1546 @vindex ps-page-dimensions-database
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1547 The variable @code{ps-paper-type} specifies which size of paper to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1548 format for; legitimate values include @code{a4}, @code{a3},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1549 @code{a4small}, @code{b4}, @code{b5}, @code{executive}, @code{ledger},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1550 @code{legal}, @code{letter}, @code{letter-small}, @code{statement},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1551 @code{tabloid}. The default is @code{letter}. You can define
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1552 additional paper sizes by changing the variable
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1553 @code{ps-page-dimensions-database}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1554
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1555 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1556 The variable @code{ps-landscape-mode} specifies the orientation of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1557 printing on the page. The default is @code{nil}, which stands for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1558 ``portrait'' mode. Any non-@code{nil} value specifies ``landscape''
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1559 mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1560
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1561 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1562 The variable @code{ps-number-of-columns} specifies the number of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1563 columns; it takes effect in both landscape and portrait mode. The
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1564 default is 1.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1565
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1566 @vindex ps-font-family
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1567 @vindex ps-font-size
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1568 @vindex ps-font-info-database
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1569 The variable @code{ps-font-family} specifies which font family to use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1570 for printing ordinary text. Legitimate values include @code{Courier},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1571 @code{Helvetica}, @code{NewCenturySchlbk}, @code{Palatino} and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1572 @code{Times}. The variable @code{ps-font-size} specifies the size of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1573 the font for ordinary text. It defaults to 8.5 points.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1574
37018
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1575 @vindex ps-multibyte-buffer
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1576 @cindex Intlfonts for PostScript printing
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1577 @cindex fonts for PostScript printing
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1578 Emacs supports more scripts and characters than a typical PostScript
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1579 printer. Thus, some of the characters in your buffer might not be
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1580 printable using the fonts built into your printer. You can augment
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1581 the fonts supplied with the printer with those from the GNU Intlfonts
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1582 package, or you can instruct Emacs to use Intlfonts exclusively. The
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1583 variable @code{ps-multibyte-buffer} controls this: the default value,
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52701
diff changeset
1584 @code{nil}, is appropriate for printing @acronym{ASCII} and Latin-1
37018
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1585 characters; a value of @code{non-latin-printer} is for printers which
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52701
diff changeset
1586 have the fonts for @acronym{ASCII}, Latin-1, Japanese, and Korean
37018
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1587 characters built into them. A value of @code{bdf-font} arranges for
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1588 the BDF fonts from the Intlfonts package to be used for @emph{all}
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1589 characters. Finally, a value of @code{bdf-font-except-latin}
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52701
diff changeset
1590 instructs the printer to use built-in fonts for @acronym{ASCII} and Latin-1
37018
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1591 characters, and Intlfonts BDF fonts for the rest.
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1592
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1593 @vindex bdf-directory-list
38599
29e540f10e62 Proofreading changes from JDonner <jdonner0@earthlink.net>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38467
diff changeset
1594 To be able to use the BDF fonts, Emacs needs to know where to find
37018
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1595 them. The variable @code{bdf-directory-list} holds the list of
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1596 directories where Emacs should look for the fonts; the default value
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1597 includes a single directory @file{/usr/local/share/emacs/fonts/bdf}.
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1598
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1599 Many other customization variables for these commands are defined and
37018
6883b349cfd6 (PostScript Variables): Explain how to set up use of
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36263
diff changeset
1600 described in the Lisp files @file{ps-print.el} and @file{ps-mule.el}.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1601
63004
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1602 @node Printing Package,, PostScript Variables, Printing
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1603 @section Printing Package
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1604 @cindex Printing package
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1605
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1606 The basic Emacs facilities for printing hardcopy can be extended
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1607 using the Printing package. This provides an easy-to-use interface
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1608 for choosing what to print, previewing PostScript files before
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1609 printing, and setting various printing options such as print headers,
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1610 landscape or portrait modes, duplex modes, and so forth. On GNU/Linux
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1611 or Unix systems, the Printing package relies on the @file{gs} and
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1612 @file{gv} utilities, which are distributed as part of the GhostScript
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1613 program. On MS-Windows, the @file{gstools} port of Ghostscript can be
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1614 used.
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1615
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1616 @findex pr-interface
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1617 To use the Printing package, add @code{(require 'printing)} to your
63069
e9052cfb189a (Printing Package): Explain how to initialize printing package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 63004
diff changeset
1618 init file (@pxref{Init File}), followed by @code{(pr-update-menus)}.
e9052cfb189a (Printing Package): Explain how to initialize printing package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 63004
diff changeset
1619 This function replaces the usual printing commands in the menu bar
e9052cfb189a (Printing Package): Explain how to initialize printing package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 63004
diff changeset
1620 with a @samp{Printing} submenu that contains various printing options.
e9052cfb189a (Printing Package): Explain how to initialize printing package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 63004
diff changeset
1621 You can also type @kbd{M-x pr-interface RET}; this creates a
e9052cfb189a (Printing Package): Explain how to initialize printing package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 63004
diff changeset
1622 @samp{*Printing Interface*} buffer, similar to a customization buffer,
e9052cfb189a (Printing Package): Explain how to initialize printing package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 63004
diff changeset
1623 where you can set the printing options. After selecting what and how
e9052cfb189a (Printing Package): Explain how to initialize printing package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 63004
diff changeset
1624 to print, you start the print job using the @samp{Print} button (click
e9052cfb189a (Printing Package): Explain how to initialize printing package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 63004
diff changeset
1625 @kbd{mouse-2} on it, or move point over it and type @kbd{RET}). For
e9052cfb189a (Printing Package): Explain how to initialize printing package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 63004
diff changeset
1626 further information on the various options, use the @samp{Interface
e9052cfb189a (Printing Package): Explain how to initialize printing package.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 63004
diff changeset
1627 Help} button.
63004
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1628
740a0db30c0a (Printing): Rename node from Hardcopy. Mention menu bar options.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 62473
diff changeset
1629 @node Sorting, Narrowing, Printing, Top
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1630 @section Sorting Text
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1631 @cindex sorting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1632
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1633 Emacs provides several commands for sorting text in the buffer. All
60432
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
1634 operate on the contents of the region.
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
1635 They divide the text of the region into many @dfn{sort records},
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1636 identify a @dfn{sort key} for each record, and then reorder the records
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1637 into the order determined by the sort keys. The records are ordered so
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1638 that their keys are in alphabetical order, or, for numeric sorting, in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1639 numeric order. In alphabetic sorting, all upper-case letters `A' through
52979
3649390c0f91 Replace @sc{ascii} and ASCII with @acronym{ASCII}.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 52701
diff changeset
1640 `Z' come before lower-case `a', in accord with the @acronym{ASCII} character
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1641 sequence.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1642
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1643 The various sort commands differ in how they divide the text into sort
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1644 records and in which part of each record is used as the sort key. Most of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1645 the commands make each line a separate sort record, but some commands use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1646 paragraphs or pages as sort records. Most of the sort commands use each
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1647 entire sort record as its own sort key, but some use only a portion of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1648 record as the sort key.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1649
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1650 @findex sort-lines
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1651 @findex sort-paragraphs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1652 @findex sort-pages
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1653 @findex sort-fields
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1654 @findex sort-numeric-fields
27469
98f24cb3efa5 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27306
diff changeset
1655 @vindex sort-numeric-base
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1656 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1657 @item M-x sort-lines
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1658 Divide the region into lines, and sort by comparing the entire
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1659 text of a line. A numeric argument means sort into descending order.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1660
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1661 @item M-x sort-paragraphs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1662 Divide the region into paragraphs, and sort by comparing the entire
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1663 text of a paragraph (except for leading blank lines). A numeric
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1664 argument means sort into descending order.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1665
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1666 @item M-x sort-pages
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1667 Divide the region into pages, and sort by comparing the entire
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1668 text of a page (except for leading blank lines). A numeric
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1669 argument means sort into descending order.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1670
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1671 @item M-x sort-fields
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1672 Divide the region into lines, and sort by comparing the contents of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1673 one field in each line. Fields are defined as separated by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1674 whitespace, so the first run of consecutive non-whitespace characters
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1675 in a line constitutes field 1, the second such run constitutes field
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1676 2, etc.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1677
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1678 Specify which field to sort by with a numeric argument: 1 to sort by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1679 field 1, etc. A negative argument means count fields from the right
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1680 instead of from the left; thus, minus 1 means sort by the last field.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1681 If several lines have identical contents in the field being sorted, they
38599
29e540f10e62 Proofreading changes from JDonner <jdonner0@earthlink.net>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38467
diff changeset
1682 keep the same relative order that they had in the original buffer.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1683
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1684 @item M-x sort-numeric-fields
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1685 Like @kbd{M-x sort-fields} except the specified field is converted
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1686 to an integer for each line, and the numbers are compared. @samp{10}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1687 comes before @samp{2} when considered as text, but after it when
27469
98f24cb3efa5 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27306
diff changeset
1688 considered as a number. By default, numbers are interpreted according
98f24cb3efa5 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27306
diff changeset
1689 to @code{sort-numeric-base}, but numbers beginning with @samp{0x} or
98f24cb3efa5 *** empty log message ***
Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>
parents: 27306
diff changeset
1690 @samp{0} are interpreted as hexadecimal and octal, respectively.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1691
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1692 @item M-x sort-columns
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1693 Like @kbd{M-x sort-fields} except that the text within each line
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1694 used for comparison comes from a fixed range of columns. See below
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1695 for an explanation.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1696
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1697 @item M-x reverse-region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1698 Reverse the order of the lines in the region. This is useful for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1699 sorting into descending order by fields or columns, since those sort
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1700 commands do not have a feature for doing that.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1701 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1702
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1703 For example, if the buffer contains this:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1704
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1705 @smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1706 On systems where clash detection (locking of files being edited) is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1707 implemented, Emacs also checks the first time you modify a buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1708 whether the file has changed on disk since it was last visited or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1709 saved. If it has, you are asked to confirm that you want to change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1710 the buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1711 @end smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1712
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1713 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1714 applying @kbd{M-x sort-lines} to the entire buffer produces this:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1715
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1716 @smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1717 On systems where clash detection (locking of files being edited) is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1718 implemented, Emacs also checks the first time you modify a buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1719 saved. If it has, you are asked to confirm that you want to change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1720 the buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1721 whether the file has changed on disk since it was last visited or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1722 @end smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1723
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1724 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1725 where the upper-case @samp{O} sorts before all lower-case letters. If
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1726 you use @kbd{C-u 2 M-x sort-fields} instead, you get this:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1727
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1728 @smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1729 implemented, Emacs also checks the first time you modify a buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1730 saved. If it has, you are asked to confirm that you want to change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1731 the buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1732 On systems where clash detection (locking of files being edited) is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1733 whether the file has changed on disk since it was last visited or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1734 @end smallexample
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1735
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1736 @noindent
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1737 where the sort keys were @samp{Emacs}, @samp{If}, @samp{buffer},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1738 @samp{systems} and @samp{the}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1739
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1740 @findex sort-columns
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1741 @kbd{M-x sort-columns} requires more explanation. You specify the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1742 columns by putting point at one of the columns and the mark at the other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1743 column. Because this means you cannot put point or the mark at the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1744 beginning of the first line of the text you want to sort, this command
36185
62cf166239f3 Change in quoting.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36168
diff changeset
1745 uses an unusual definition of ``region'': all of the line point is in is
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1746 considered part of the region, and so is all of the line the mark is in,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1747 as well as all the lines in between.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1748
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1749 For example, to sort a table by information found in columns 10 to 15,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1750 you could put the mark on column 10 in the first line of the table, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1751 point on column 15 in the last line of the table, and then run
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1752 @code{sort-columns}. Equivalently, you could run it with the mark on
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1753 column 15 in the first line and point on column 10 in the last line.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1754
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1755 This can be thought of as sorting the rectangle specified by point and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1756 the mark, except that the text on each line to the left or right of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1757 rectangle moves along with the text inside the rectangle.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1758 @xref{Rectangles}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1759
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1760 @vindex sort-fold-case
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1761 Many of the sort commands ignore case differences when comparing, if
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1762 @code{sort-fold-case} is non-@code{nil}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1763
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1764 @node Narrowing, Two-Column, Sorting, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1765 @section Narrowing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1766 @cindex widening
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1767 @cindex restriction
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1768 @cindex narrowing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1769 @cindex accessible portion
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1770
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1771 @dfn{Narrowing} means focusing in on some portion of the buffer,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1772 making the rest temporarily inaccessible. The portion which you can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1773 still get to is called the @dfn{accessible portion}. Canceling the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1774 narrowing, which makes the entire buffer once again accessible, is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1775 called @dfn{widening}. The amount of narrowing in effect in a buffer at
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1776 any time is called the buffer's @dfn{restriction}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1777
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1778 Narrowing can make it easier to concentrate on a single subroutine or
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1779 paragraph by eliminating clutter. It can also be used to restrict the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1780 range of operation of a replace command or repeating keyboard macro.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1781
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1782 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1783 @item C-x n n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1784 Narrow down to between point and mark (@code{narrow-to-region}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1785 @item C-x n w
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1786 Widen to make the entire buffer accessible again (@code{widen}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1787 @item C-x n p
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1788 Narrow down to the current page (@code{narrow-to-page}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1789 @item C-x n d
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1790 Narrow down to the current defun (@code{narrow-to-defun}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1791 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1792
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1793 When you have narrowed down to a part of the buffer, that part appears
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1794 to be all there is. You can't see the rest, you can't move into it
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1795 (motion commands won't go outside the accessible part), you can't change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1796 it in any way. However, it is not gone, and if you save the file all
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1797 the inaccessible text will be saved. The word @samp{Narrow} appears in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1798 the mode line whenever narrowing is in effect.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1799
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1800 @kindex C-x n n
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1801 @findex narrow-to-region
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1802 The primary narrowing command is @kbd{C-x n n} (@code{narrow-to-region}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1803 It sets the current buffer's restrictions so that the text in the current
38599
29e540f10e62 Proofreading changes from JDonner <jdonner0@earthlink.net>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38467
diff changeset
1804 region remains accessible, but all text before the region or after the
29e540f10e62 Proofreading changes from JDonner <jdonner0@earthlink.net>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38467
diff changeset
1805 region is inaccessible. Point and mark do not change.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1806
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1807 @kindex C-x n p
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1808 @findex narrow-to-page
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1809 @kindex C-x n d
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1810 @findex narrow-to-defun
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1811 Alternatively, use @kbd{C-x n p} (@code{narrow-to-page}) to narrow
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1812 down to the current page. @xref{Pages}, for the definition of a page.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1813 @kbd{C-x n d} (@code{narrow-to-defun}) narrows down to the defun
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1814 containing point (@pxref{Defuns}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1815
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1816 @kindex C-x n w
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1817 @findex widen
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1818 The way to cancel narrowing is to widen with @kbd{C-x n w}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1819 (@code{widen}). This makes all text in the buffer accessible again.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1820
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1821 You can get information on what part of the buffer you are narrowed down
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1822 to using the @kbd{C-x =} command. @xref{Position Info}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1823
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1824 Because narrowing can easily confuse users who do not understand it,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1825 @code{narrow-to-region} is normally a disabled command. Attempting to use
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1826 this command asks for confirmation and gives you the option of enabling it;
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1827 if you enable the command, confirmation will no longer be required for
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1828 it. @xref{Disabling}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1830 @node Two-Column, Editing Binary Files, Narrowing, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1831 @section Two-Column Editing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1832 @cindex two-column editing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1833 @cindex splitting columns
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1834 @cindex columns, splitting
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1835
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1836 Two-column mode lets you conveniently edit two side-by-side columns of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1837 text. It uses two side-by-side windows, each showing its own
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1838 buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1839
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1840 There are three ways to enter two-column mode:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1841
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1842 @table @asis
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1843 @item @kbd{@key{F2} 2} or @kbd{C-x 6 2}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1844 @kindex F2 2
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1845 @kindex C-x 6 2
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1846 @findex 2C-two-columns
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1847 Enter two-column mode with the current buffer on the left, and on the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1848 right, a buffer whose name is based on the current buffer's name
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1849 (@code{2C-two-columns}). If the right-hand buffer doesn't already
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1850 exist, it starts out empty; the current buffer's contents are not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1851 changed.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1852
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1853 This command is appropriate when the current buffer is empty or contains
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1854 just one column and you want to add another column.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1855
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1856 @item @kbd{@key{F2} s} or @kbd{C-x 6 s}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1857 @kindex F2 s
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1858 @kindex C-x 6 s
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1859 @findex 2C-split
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1860 Split the current buffer, which contains two-column text, into two
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1861 buffers, and display them side by side (@code{2C-split}). The current
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1862 buffer becomes the left-hand buffer, but the text in the right-hand
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1863 column is moved into the right-hand buffer. The current column
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1864 specifies the split point. Splitting starts with the current line and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1865 continues to the end of the buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1866
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1867 This command is appropriate when you have a buffer that already contains
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1868 two-column text, and you wish to separate the columns temporarily.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1869
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1870 @item @kbd{@key{F2} b @var{buffer} @key{RET}}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1871 @itemx @kbd{C-x 6 b @var{buffer} @key{RET}}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1872 @kindex F2 b
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1873 @kindex C-x 6 b
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1874 @findex 2C-associate-buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1875 Enter two-column mode using the current buffer as the left-hand buffer,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1876 and using buffer @var{buffer} as the right-hand buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1877 (@code{2C-associate-buffer}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1878 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1879
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1880 @kbd{@key{F2} s} or @kbd{C-x 6 s} looks for a column separator, which
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1881 is a string that appears on each line between the two columns. You can
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1882 specify the width of the separator with a numeric argument to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1883 @kbd{@key{F2} s}; that many characters, before point, constitute the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1884 separator string. By default, the width is 1, so the column separator
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1885 is the character before point.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1886
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1887 When a line has the separator at the proper place, @kbd{@key{F2} s}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1888 puts the text after the separator into the right-hand buffer, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1889 deletes the separator. Lines that don't have the column separator at
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1890 the proper place remain unsplit; they stay in the left-hand buffer, and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1891 the right-hand buffer gets an empty line to correspond. (This is the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1892 way to write a line that ``spans both columns while in two-column
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1893 mode'': write it in the left-hand buffer, and put an empty line in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1894 right-hand buffer.)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1895
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1896 @kindex F2 RET
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1897 @kindex C-x 6 RET
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1898 @findex 2C-newline
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1899 The command @kbd{C-x 6 @key{RET}} or @kbd{@key{F2} @key{RET}}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1900 (@code{2C-newline}) inserts a newline in each of the two buffers at
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1901 corresponding positions. This is the easiest way to add a new line to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1902 the two-column text while editing it in split buffers.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1903
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1904 @kindex F2 1
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1905 @kindex C-x 6 1
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1906 @findex 2C-merge
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1907 When you have edited both buffers as you wish, merge them with
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1908 @kbd{@key{F2} 1} or @kbd{C-x 6 1} (@code{2C-merge}). This copies the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1909 text from the right-hand buffer as a second column in the other buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1910 To go back to two-column editing, use @kbd{@key{F2} s}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1911
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1912 @kindex F2 d
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1913 @kindex C-x 6 d
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1914 @findex 2C-dissociate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1915 Use @kbd{@key{F2} d} or @kbd{C-x 6 d} to dissociate the two buffers,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1916 leaving each as it stands (@code{2C-dissociate}). If the other buffer,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1917 the one not current when you type @kbd{@key{F2} d}, is empty,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1918 @kbd{@key{F2} d} kills it.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1919
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1920 @node Editing Binary Files, Saving Emacs Sessions, Two-Column, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1921 @section Editing Binary Files
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1922
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1923 @cindex Hexl mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1924 @cindex mode, Hexl
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1925 @cindex editing binary files
31029
29d46c0c8156 Update the Hexl node.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 30862
diff changeset
1926 @cindex hex editing
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1927 There is a special major mode for editing binary files: Hexl mode. To
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1928 use it, use @kbd{M-x hexl-find-file} instead of @kbd{C-x C-f} to visit
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1929 the file. This command converts the file's contents to hexadecimal and
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1930 lets you edit the translation. When you save the file, it is converted
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1931 automatically back to binary.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1932
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1933 You can also use @kbd{M-x hexl-mode} to translate an existing buffer
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1934 into hex. This is useful if you visit a file normally and then discover
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1935 it is a binary file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1936
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1937 Ordinary text characters overwrite in Hexl mode. This is to reduce
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1938 the risk of accidentally spoiling the alignment of data in the file.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1939 There are special commands for insertion. Here is a list of the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1940 commands of Hexl mode:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1941
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1942 @c I don't think individual index entries for these commands are useful--RMS.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1943 @table @kbd
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1944 @item C-M-d
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1945 Insert a byte with a code typed in decimal.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1946
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1947 @item C-M-o
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1948 Insert a byte with a code typed in octal.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1949
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1950 @item C-M-x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1951 Insert a byte with a code typed in hex.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1952
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1953 @item C-x [
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1954 Move to the beginning of a 1k-byte ``page.''
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1955
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1956 @item C-x ]
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1957 Move to the end of a 1k-byte ``page.''
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1958
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1959 @item M-g
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1960 Move to an address specified in hex.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1961
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1962 @item M-j
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1963 Move to an address specified in decimal.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1964
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1965 @item C-c C-c
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1966 Leave Hexl mode, going back to the major mode this buffer had before you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1967 invoked @code{hexl-mode}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1968 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1969
31029
29d46c0c8156 Update the Hexl node.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 30862
diff changeset
1970 @noindent
37846
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
1971 Other Hexl commands let you insert strings (sequences) of binary
38599
29e540f10e62 Proofreading changes from JDonner <jdonner0@earthlink.net>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38467
diff changeset
1972 bytes, move by @code{short}s or @code{int}s, etc.; type @kbd{C-h a
29e540f10e62 Proofreading changes from JDonner <jdonner0@earthlink.net>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38467
diff changeset
1973 hexl-@key{RET}} for details.
31029
29d46c0c8156 Update the Hexl node.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 30862
diff changeset
1974
29d46c0c8156 Update the Hexl node.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 30862
diff changeset
1975
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1976 @node Saving Emacs Sessions, Recursive Edit, Editing Binary Files, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1977 @section Saving Emacs Sessions
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1978 @cindex saving sessions
38025
64ee3e7394ed Add a few more index entries for desktop.el.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38017
diff changeset
1979 @cindex restore session
64ee3e7394ed Add a few more index entries for desktop.el.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38017
diff changeset
1980 @cindex remember editing session
64ee3e7394ed Add a few more index entries for desktop.el.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38017
diff changeset
1981 @cindex reload files
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1982 @cindex desktop
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1983
52701
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
1984 Use the desktop library to save the state of Emacs from one session
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
1985 to another. Once you save the Emacs @dfn{desktop}---the buffers,
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
1986 their file names, major modes, buffer positions, and so on---then
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
1987 subsequent Emacs sessions reload the saved desktop.
52675
131935ba4b30 Section "Saving Emacs Sessions" rewritten.
Lars Hansen <larsh@soem.dk>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1988
52701
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
1989 @findex desktop-save
52675
131935ba4b30 Section "Saving Emacs Sessions" rewritten.
Lars Hansen <larsh@soem.dk>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1990 @vindex desktop-save-mode
52701
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
1991 You can save the desktop manually with the command @kbd{M-x
60432
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
1992 desktop-save}. You can also enable automatic desktop saving when
52701
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
1993 you exit Emacs: use the Customization buffer (@pxref{Easy
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
1994 Customization}) to set @code{desktop-save-mode} to @code{t} for future
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
1995 sessions, or add this line in your @file{~/.emacs} file:
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1996
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1997 @example
52675
131935ba4b30 Section "Saving Emacs Sessions" rewritten.
Lars Hansen <larsh@soem.dk>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
1998 (desktop-save-mode 1)
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
1999 @end example
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2000
52675
131935ba4b30 Section "Saving Emacs Sessions" rewritten.
Lars Hansen <larsh@soem.dk>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
2001 @findex desktop-change-dir
131935ba4b30 Section "Saving Emacs Sessions" rewritten.
Lars Hansen <larsh@soem.dk>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
2002 @findex desktop-revert
52701
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
2003 When Emacs starts, it looks for a saved desktop in the current
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
2004 directory. Thus, you can have separate saved desktops in different
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
2005 directories, and the starting directory determines which one Emacs
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
2006 reloads. You can save the current desktop and reload one saved in
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
2007 another directory by typing @kbd{M-x desktop-change-dir}. Typing
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
2008 @kbd{M-x desktop-revert} reverts to the desktop previously reloaded.
52675
131935ba4b30 Section "Saving Emacs Sessions" rewritten.
Lars Hansen <larsh@soem.dk>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
2009
52701
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
2010 Specify the option @samp{--no-desktop} on the command line when you
61639
ed1c184086c0 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Add that "--no-desktop" turns off desktop-save-mode.
Lars Hansen <larsh@soem.dk>
parents: 61102
diff changeset
2011 don't want it to reload any saved desktop. This turns off
ed1c184086c0 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Add that "--no-desktop" turns off desktop-save-mode.
Lars Hansen <larsh@soem.dk>
parents: 61102
diff changeset
2012 @code{desktop-save-mode} for the current session.
52675
131935ba4b30 Section "Saving Emacs Sessions" rewritten.
Lars Hansen <larsh@soem.dk>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
2013
60799
bab476ff521c (Saving Emacs Sessions): Document desktop-restore-eager.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60496
diff changeset
2014 @vindex desktop-restore-eager
bab476ff521c (Saving Emacs Sessions): Document desktop-restore-eager.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60496
diff changeset
2015 By default, all the buffers in the desktop are restored at one go.
bab476ff521c (Saving Emacs Sessions): Document desktop-restore-eager.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60496
diff changeset
2016 However, this may be slow if there are a lot of buffers in the
bab476ff521c (Saving Emacs Sessions): Document desktop-restore-eager.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60496
diff changeset
2017 desktop. You can specify the maximum number of buffers to restore
bab476ff521c (Saving Emacs Sessions): Document desktop-restore-eager.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60496
diff changeset
2018 immediately with the variable @code{desktop-restore-eager}; the
bab476ff521c (Saving Emacs Sessions): Document desktop-restore-eager.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60496
diff changeset
2019 remaining buffers are restored ``lazily,'' when Emacs is idle.
bab476ff521c (Saving Emacs Sessions): Document desktop-restore-eager.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 60496
diff changeset
2020
52675
131935ba4b30 Section "Saving Emacs Sessions" rewritten.
Lars Hansen <larsh@soem.dk>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
2021 @findex desktop-clear
131935ba4b30 Section "Saving Emacs Sessions" rewritten.
Lars Hansen <larsh@soem.dk>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
2022 @vindex desktop-globals-to-clear
131935ba4b30 Section "Saving Emacs Sessions" rewritten.
Lars Hansen <larsh@soem.dk>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
2023 @vindex desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp
52701
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
2024 Type @kbd{M-x desktop-clear} to empty the Emacs desktop. This kills
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
2025 all buffers except for internal ones, and clears the global variables
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
2026 listed in @code{desktop-globals-to-clear}. If you want this to
52675
131935ba4b30 Section "Saving Emacs Sessions" rewritten.
Lars Hansen <larsh@soem.dk>
parents: 52401
diff changeset
2027 preserve certain buffers, customize the variable
52701
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
2028 @code{desktop-clear-preserve-buffers-regexp}, whose value is a regular
594b1eb2dd76 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Shorten the section, collapsing back into one node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 52675
diff changeset
2029 expression matching the names of buffers not to kill.
29083
17c7b5770672 Saveplace
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28448
diff changeset
2030
66098
ac281b254006 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Mention savehist library.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 64890
diff changeset
2031 If you want to save minibuffer history from one session to
ac281b254006 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Mention savehist library.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 64890
diff changeset
2032 another, use the @code{savehist} library.
ac281b254006 (Saving Emacs Sessions): Mention savehist library.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 64890
diff changeset
2033
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2034 @node Recursive Edit, Emulation, Saving Emacs Sessions, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2035 @section Recursive Editing Levels
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2036 @cindex recursive editing level
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2037 @cindex editing level, recursive
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2038
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2039 A @dfn{recursive edit} is a situation in which you are using Emacs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2040 commands to perform arbitrary editing while in the middle of another
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2041 Emacs command. For example, when you type @kbd{C-r} inside of a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2042 @code{query-replace}, you enter a recursive edit in which you can change
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2043 the current buffer. On exiting from the recursive edit, you go back to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2044 the @code{query-replace}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2045
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2046 @kindex C-M-c
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2047 @findex exit-recursive-edit
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2048 @cindex exiting recursive edit
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2049 @dfn{Exiting} the recursive edit means returning to the unfinished
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2050 command, which continues execution. The command to exit is @kbd{C-M-c}
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2051 (@code{exit-recursive-edit}).
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2052
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2053 You can also @dfn{abort} the recursive edit. This is like exiting,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2054 but also quits the unfinished command immediately. Use the command
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2055 @kbd{C-]} (@code{abort-recursive-edit}) to do this. @xref{Quitting}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2056
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2057 The mode line shows you when you are in a recursive edit by displaying
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2058 square brackets around the parentheses that always surround the major and
38599
29e540f10e62 Proofreading changes from JDonner <jdonner0@earthlink.net>.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 38467
diff changeset
2059 minor mode names. Every window's mode line shows this in the same way,
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2060 since being in a recursive edit is true of Emacs as a whole rather than
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2061 any particular window or buffer.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2062
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2063 It is possible to be in recursive edits within recursive edits. For
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2064 example, after typing @kbd{C-r} in a @code{query-replace}, you may type a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2065 command that enters the debugger. This begins a recursive editing level
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2066 for the debugger, within the recursive editing level for @kbd{C-r}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2067 Mode lines display a pair of square brackets for each recursive editing
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2068 level currently in progress.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2069
60432
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
2070 Exiting the inner recursive edit (such as with the debugger @kbd{c}
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2071 command) resumes the command running in the next level up. When that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2072 command finishes, you can then use @kbd{C-M-c} to exit another recursive
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2073 editing level, and so on. Exiting applies to the innermost level only.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2074 Aborting also gets out of only one level of recursive edit; it returns
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2075 immediately to the command level of the previous recursive edit. If you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2076 wish, you can then abort the next recursive editing level.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2077
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2078 Alternatively, the command @kbd{M-x top-level} aborts all levels of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2079 recursive edits, returning immediately to the top-level command reader.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2080
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2081 The text being edited inside the recursive edit need not be the same text
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2082 that you were editing at top level. It depends on what the recursive edit
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2083 is for. If the command that invokes the recursive edit selects a different
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2084 buffer first, that is the buffer you will edit recursively. In any case,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2085 you can switch buffers within the recursive edit in the normal manner (as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2086 long as the buffer-switching keys have not been rebound). You could
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2087 probably do all the rest of your editing inside the recursive edit,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2088 visiting files and all. But this could have surprising effects (such as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2089 stack overflow) from time to time. So remember to exit or abort the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2090 recursive edit when you no longer need it.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2091
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2092 In general, we try to minimize the use of recursive editing levels in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2093 GNU Emacs. This is because they constrain you to ``go back'' in a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2094 particular order---from the innermost level toward the top level. When
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2095 possible, we present different activities in separate buffers so that
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2096 you can switch between them as you please. Some commands switch to a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2097 new major mode which provides a command to switch back. These
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2098 approaches give you more flexibility to go back to unfinished tasks in
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2099 the order you choose.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2100
28448
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2101 @node Emulation, Hyperlinking, Recursive Edit, Top
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2102 @section Emulation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2103 @cindex emulating other editors
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2104 @cindex other editors
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2105 @cindex EDT
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2106 @cindex vi
39263
343d48d4e64c Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39061
diff changeset
2107 @cindex PC key bindings
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2108 @cindex scrolling all windows
39263
343d48d4e64c Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39061
diff changeset
2109 @cindex PC selection
343d48d4e64c Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39061
diff changeset
2110 @cindex Motif key bindings
343d48d4e64c Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39061
diff changeset
2111 @cindex Macintosh key bindings
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2112 @cindex WordStar
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2113
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2114 GNU Emacs can be programmed to emulate (more or less) most other
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2115 editors. Standard facilities can emulate these:
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2116
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2117 @table @asis
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2118 @item CRiSP/Brief (PC editor)
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2119 @findex crisp-mode
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2120 @vindex crisp-override-meta-x
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2121 @findex scroll-all-mode
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2122 @cindex CRiSP mode
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2123 @cindex Brief emulation
36263
11db0318031d Remove redundant index entries.
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 36185
diff changeset
2124 @cindex emulation of Brief
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2125 @cindex mode, CRiSP
39263
343d48d4e64c Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39061
diff changeset
2126 You can turn on key bindings to emulate the CRiSP/Brief editor with
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2127 @kbd{M-x crisp-mode}. Note that this rebinds @kbd{M-x} to exit Emacs
59798
0816b427495a Don't say just "option" when talking about variables.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58928
diff changeset
2128 unless you set the variable @code{crisp-override-meta-x}. You can
0816b427495a Don't say just "option" when talking about variables.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 58928
diff changeset
2129 also use the command @kbd{M-x scroll-all-mode} or set the variable
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2130 @code{crisp-load-scroll-all} to emulate CRiSP's scroll-all feature
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2131 (scrolling all windows together).
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2132
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2133 @item EDT (DEC VMS editor)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2134 @findex edt-emulation-on
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2135 @findex edt-emulation-off
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2136 Turn on EDT emulation with @kbd{M-x edt-emulation-on}. @kbd{M-x
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2137 edt-emulation-off} restores normal Emacs command bindings.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2138
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2139 Most of the EDT emulation commands are keypad keys, and most standard
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2140 Emacs key bindings are still available. The EDT emulation rebindings
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2141 are done in the global keymap, so there is no problem switching
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2142 buffers or major modes while in EDT emulation.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2143
28448
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2144 @item TPU (DEC VMS editor)
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2145 @findex tpu-edt-on
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2146 @cindex TPU
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2147 @kbd{M-x tpu-edt-on} turns on emulation of the TPU editor emulating EDT.
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2148
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2149 @item vi (Berkeley editor)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2150 @findex viper-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2151 Viper is the newest emulator for vi. It implements several levels of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2152 emulation; level 1 is closest to vi itself, while level 5 departs
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2153 somewhat from strict emulation to take advantage of the capabilities of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2154 Emacs. To invoke Viper, type @kbd{M-x viper-mode}; it will guide you
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2155 the rest of the way and ask for the emulation level. @inforef{Top,
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2156 Viper, viper}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2157
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2158 @item vi (another emulator)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2159 @findex vi-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2160 @kbd{M-x vi-mode} enters a major mode that replaces the previously
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2161 established major mode. All of the vi commands that, in real vi, enter
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2162 ``input'' mode are programmed instead to return to the previous major
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2163 mode. Thus, ordinary Emacs serves as vi's ``input'' mode.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2164
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2165 Because vi emulation works through major modes, it does not work
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2166 to switch buffers during emulation. Return to normal Emacs first.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2167
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2168 If you plan to use vi emulation much, you probably want to bind a key
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2169 to the @code{vi-mode} command.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2170
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2171 @item vi (alternate emulator)
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2172 @findex vip-mode
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2173 @kbd{M-x vip-mode} invokes another vi emulator, said to resemble real vi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2174 more thoroughly than @kbd{M-x vi-mode}. ``Input'' mode in this emulator
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2175 is changed from ordinary Emacs so you can use @key{ESC} to go back to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2176 emulated vi command mode. To get from emulated vi command mode back to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2177 ordinary Emacs, type @kbd{C-z}.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2178
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2179 This emulation does not work through major modes, and it is possible
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2180 to switch buffers in various ways within the emulator. It is not
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2181 so necessary to assign a key to the command @code{vip-mode} as
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2182 it is with @code{vi-mode} because terminating insert mode does
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2183 not use it.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2184
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2185 @inforef{Top, VIP, vip}, for full information.
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2186
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2187 @item WordStar (old wordprocessor)
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2188 @findex wordstar-mode
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2189 @kbd{M-x wordstar-mode} provides a major mode with WordStar-like
39263
343d48d4e64c Spelling corrections.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 39061
diff changeset
2190 key bindings.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2191 @end table
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2192
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2193 @node Hyperlinking, Thumbnails, Emulation, Top
28448
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2194 @section Hyperlinking and Navigation Features
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2195
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2196 @cindex hyperlinking
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2197 @cindex navigation
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2198 Various modes documented elsewhere have hypertext features so that
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2199 you can follow links, usually by clicking @kbd{Mouse-2} on the link or
60432
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
2200 typing @key{RET} while point is on the link. Clicking @kbd{Mouse-1}
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
2201 quickly on the link also follows it. (Hold @kbd{Mouse-1} for longer
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
2202 if you want to set point instead.)
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
2203
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
2204 Info mode, Help mode and the Dired-like modes are examples of modes
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
2205 that have links in the buffer. The Tags facility links between uses
1dd713cadb8a (Single Shell): Replace uudecode example with gpg example.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 59798
diff changeset
2206 and definitions in source files, see @ref{Tags}. Imenu provides
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2207 navigation amongst items indexed in the current buffer, see
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2208 @ref{Imenu}. Info-lookup provides mode-specific lookup of definitions
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2209 in Info indexes, see @ref{Documentation}. Speedbar maintains a frame
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2210 in which links to files, and locations in files are displayed, see
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2211 @ref{Speedbar}.
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2212
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2213 Other non-mode-specific facilities described in this section enable
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2214 following links from the current buffer in a context-sensitive
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2215 fashion.
28448
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2216
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2217 @menu
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2218 * Browse-URL:: Following URLs.
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2219 * Goto-address:: Activating URLs.
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2220 * FFAP:: Finding files etc. at point.
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2221 @end menu
28448
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2222
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2223 @node Browse-URL
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2224 @subsection Following URLs
28448
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2225 @cindex World Wide Web
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2226 @cindex Web
28448
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2227 @findex browse-url
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2228 @findex browse-url-at-point
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2229 @findex browse-url-at-mouse
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2230 @cindex Browse-URL
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2231 @cindex URLs
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2232
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2233 @table @kbd
37846
d8b197c6f26d Explain M-! output can go in echo area.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 37018
diff changeset
2234 @item M-x browse-url @key{RET} @var{url} @key{RET}
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2235 Load a URL into a Web browser.
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2236 @end table
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2237
28448
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2238 The Browse-URL package provides facilities for following URLs specifying
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2239 links on the World Wide Web. Usually this works by invoking a web
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2240 browser, but you can, for instance, arrange to invoke @code{compose-mail}
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2241 from @samp{mailto:} URLs.
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2242
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2243 The general way to use this feature is to type @kbd{M-x browse-url},
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2244 which displays a specified URL. If point is located near a plausible
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2245 URL, that URL is used as the default. Other commands are available
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2246 which you might like to bind to keys, such as
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2247 @code{browse-url-at-point} and @code{browse-url-at-mouse}.
28448
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2248
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2249 @vindex browse-url-browser-function
38017
32f10000ac35 Don't use the British spelling of "behaviour".
Eli Zaretskii <eliz@gnu.org>
parents: 37846
diff changeset
2250 You can customize Browse-URL's behavior via various options in the
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2251 @code{browse-url} Customize group, particularly
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2252 @code{browse-url-browser-function}. You can invoke actions dependent
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2253 on the type of URL by defining @code{browse-url-browser-function} as
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2254 an association list. The package's commentary available via @kbd{C-h
54475
01fa7e81affb (Browse-URL, FFAP): Add information about keywords.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 52979
diff changeset
2255 p} under the @samp{hypermedia} keyword provides more information.
01fa7e81affb (Browse-URL, FFAP): Add information about keywords.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 52979
diff changeset
2256 Packages with facilities for following URLs should always go through
01fa7e81affb (Browse-URL, FFAP): Add information about keywords.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 52979
diff changeset
2257 Browse-URL, so that the customization options for Browse-URL will
01fa7e81affb (Browse-URL, FFAP): Add information about keywords.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 52979
diff changeset
2258 affect all browsing in Emacs.
28448
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2259
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2260 @node Goto-address
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2261 @subsection Activating URLs
28448
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2262 @findex goto-address
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2263 @cindex Goto-address
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2264 @cindex URLs, activating
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2265
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2266 @table @kbd
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2267 @item M-x goto-address
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2268 Activate URLs and e-mail addresses in the current buffer.
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2269 @end table
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2270
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2271 You can make URLs in the current buffer active with @kbd{M-x
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2272 goto-address}. This finds all the URLs in the buffer, and establishes
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2273 bindings for @kbd{Mouse-2} and @kbd{C-c @key{RET}} on them. After
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2274 activation, if you click on a URL with @kbd{Mouse-2}, or move to a URL
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2275 and type @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}, that will display the web page that the URL
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2276 specifies. For a @samp{mailto} URL, it sends mail instead, using your
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2277 selected mail-composition method (@pxref{Mail Methods}).
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2278
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2279 It can be useful to add @code{goto-address} to mode hooks and the
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2280 hooks used to display an incoming message.
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2281 @code{rmail-show-message-hook} is the appropriate hook for Rmail, and
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2282 @code{mh-show-mode-hook} for MH-E. This is not needed for Gnus,
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2283 which has a similar feature of its own.
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2284
28448
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2285
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2286 @node FFAP
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2287 @subsection Finding Files and URLs at Point
28448
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2288 @findex find-file-at-point
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2289 @findex ffap
58928
4a354500d0f8 ffap-dired-at-point -> dired-at-point
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58925
diff changeset
2290 @findex dired-at-point
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2291 @findex ffap-next
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2292 @findex ffap-menu
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2293 @cindex finding file at point
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2294
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2295 FFAP mode replaces certain key bindings for finding files, including
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2296 @kbd{C-x C-f}, with commands that provide more sensitive defaults.
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2297 These commands behave like the ordinary ones when given a prefix
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2298 argument. Otherwise, they get the default file name or URL from the
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2299 text around point. If what is found in the buffer has the form of a
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2300 URL rather than a file name, the commands use @code{browse-url} to
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2301 view it.
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2302
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2303 This feature is useful for following references in mail or news
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2304 buffers, @file{README} files, @file{MANIFEST} files, and so on. The
54475
01fa7e81affb (Browse-URL, FFAP): Add information about keywords.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 52979
diff changeset
2305 @samp{ffap} package's commentary available via @kbd{C-h p} under the
01fa7e81affb (Browse-URL, FFAP): Add information about keywords.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 52979
diff changeset
2306 @samp{files} keyword and the @code{ffap} Custom group provide details.
28448
fe21629219ef (Emulation): Mention TPU.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 28125
diff changeset
2307
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2308 @cindex FFAP minor mode
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2309 @findex ffap-mode
54475
01fa7e81affb (Browse-URL, FFAP): Add information about keywords.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 52979
diff changeset
2310 You can turn on FFAP minor mode by calling @code{ffap-bindings} to
01fa7e81affb (Browse-URL, FFAP): Add information about keywords.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 52979
diff changeset
2311 make the following key bindings and to install hooks for using
01fa7e81affb (Browse-URL, FFAP): Add information about keywords.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 52979
diff changeset
2312 @code{ffap} in Rmail, Gnus and VM article buffers.
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2313
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2314 @table @kbd
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2315 @item C-x C-f @var{filename} @key{RET}
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2316 @kindex C-x C-f @r{(FFAP)}
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2317 Find @var{filename}, guessing a default from text around point
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2318 (@code{find-file-at-point}).
58925
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2319 @item C-x C-r
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2320 @kindex C-x C-r @r{(FFAP)}
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2321 @code{ffap-read-only}, analogous to @code{find-file-read-only}.
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2322 @item C-x C-v
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2323 @kindex C-x C-v @r{(FFAP)}
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2324 @code{ffap-alternate-file}, analogous to @code{find-alternate-file}.
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2325 @item C-x d @var{directory} @key{RET}
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2326 @kindex C-x d @r{(FFAP)}
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2327 Start Dired on @var{directory}, defaulting to the directory name at
58928
4a354500d0f8 ffap-dired-at-point -> dired-at-point
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58925
diff changeset
2328 point (@code{dired-at-point}).
58925
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2329 @item C-x C-d
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2330 @code{ffap-list-directory}, analogous to @code{list-directory}.
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2331 @item C-x 4 f
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2332 @kindex C-x 4 f @r{(FFAP)}
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2333 @code{ffap-other-window}, analogous to @code{find-file-other-window}.
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2334 @item C-x 4 r
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2335 @code{ffap-read-only-other-window}, analogous to
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2336 @code{find-file-read-only-other-window}.
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2337 @item C-x 4 d
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2338 @code{ffap-dired-other-window}, analogous to @code{dired-other-window}.
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2339 @item C-x 5 f
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2340 @kindex C-x 5 f @r{(FFAP)}
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2341 @code{ffap-other-frame}, analogous to @code{find-file-other-frame}.
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2342 @item C-x 5 r
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2343 @code{ffap-read-only-other-frame}, analogous to
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2344 @code{find-file-read-only-other-frame}.
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2345 @item C-x 5 d
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2346 @code{ffap-dired-other-frame}, analogous to @code{dired-other-frame}.
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2347 @item M-x ffap-next
564c48d59721 (FFAP): Add C-x C-r, C-x C-v, C-x C-d, C-x 4 r, C-x 4 d, C-x 5 r, C-x 5 d.
Juri Linkov <juri@jurta.org>
parents: 58765
diff changeset
2348 Search buffer for next file name or URL, then find that file or URL.
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2349 @item S-Mouse-3
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2350 @kindex S-Mouse-3 @r{(FFAP)}
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2351 @code{ffap-at-mouse} finds the file guessed from text around the position
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2352 of a mouse click.
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2353 @item C-S-Mouse-3
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2354 @kindex C-S-Mouse-3 @r{(FFAP)}
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2355 Display a menu of files and URLs mentioned in current buffer, then
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2356 find the one you select (@code{ffap-menu}).
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2357 @end table
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2358
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2359 @node Thumbnails, Dissociated Press, Hyperlinking, Top
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2360 @section Viewing Images as Thumbnails
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2361 @cindex tumme mode
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2362 @cindex thumbnails
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2363
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2364 Tumme is a facility for browsing image files. It provides viewing
69788
f2d982bf90e8 (Thumbnails): Minor cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 69784
diff changeset
2365 the images either as thumbnails or in full size, either inside Emacs
f2d982bf90e8 (Thumbnails): Minor cleanup.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 69784
diff changeset
2366 or through an external viewer.
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2367
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2368 To enter Tumme, type @kbd{M-x tumme}. It prompts for a directory;
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2369 specify one that has images files. This creates thumbnails for all
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2370 the images in that directory, and displays them all in the ``thumbnail
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2371 buffer''. This takes a long time if the directory contains many image
69797
b06d1e6ea199 (Thumbnails): Minor correction.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 69788
diff changeset
2372 files, and it asks for confirmation if the number of image files
b06d1e6ea199 (Thumbnails): Minor correction.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 69788
diff changeset
2373 exceeds @code{tumme-show-all-from-dir-max-files}.
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2374
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2375 @kindex C-t d @r{(Tumme)}
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2376 @findex tumme-display-thumbs
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2377 You can also enter Tumme through Dired. Mark the image files you
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2378 want to look at, using @kbd{m} as usual, then type @kbd{C-t d}
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2379 (@code{tumme-display-thumbs}). This too creates and switches to
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2380 a buffer containing thumbnails, corresponding to the marked files.
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2381
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2382 With point in the thumbnail buffer, type @kbd{RET}
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2383 (@code{tumme-display-thumbnail-original-image}) to display a sized
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2384 version of it in another window. This sizes the image to fit the
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2385 window. Use the arrow keys to move around in the buffer. For easy
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2386 browing, type @kbd{SPC} (@code{tumme-display-next-thumbnail-original})
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2387 to advance and display the next image. Typing @kbd{DEL}
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2388 (@code{tumme-display-previous-thumbnail-original}) backs up to the
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2389 previous thumbnail and displays that instead.
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2390
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2391 @vindex tumme-external-viewer
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2392 To view and the image in its original size, either provide a prefix
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2393 argument (@kbd{C-u}) before pressing @kbd{RET}, or type @kbd{C-@key{RET}}
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2394 (@code{tumme-thumbnail-display-external}) to display the image in an
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2395 external viewer. You must first configure
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2396 @code{tumme-external-viewer}.
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2397
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2398 You can delete images through Tumme also. Type @kbd{d}
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2399 (@code{tumme-flag-thumb-original-file}) to flag the image file for
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2400 deletion in the Dired buffer. You can also delete the thumbnail image
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2401 from the thumbnail buffer with @kbd{C-d} (@code{tumme-delete-char}).
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2402
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2403 More advanced features include @dfn{image tags}, which are metadata
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2404 used to categorize image files. The tags are stored in a plain text
69784
2a84440a03fb Small additions about tumme.
Mathias Dahl <mathias.dahl@gmail.com>
parents: 69737
diff changeset
2405 file configured by @code{tumme-db-file}.
2a84440a03fb Small additions about tumme.
Mathias Dahl <mathias.dahl@gmail.com>
parents: 69737
diff changeset
2406
2a84440a03fb Small additions about tumme.
Mathias Dahl <mathias.dahl@gmail.com>
parents: 69737
diff changeset
2407 To tag image files, mark them in the dired buffer (you can also mark
2a84440a03fb Small additions about tumme.
Mathias Dahl <mathias.dahl@gmail.com>
parents: 69737
diff changeset
2408 files in Dired from the thumbnail buffer by typing @kbd{m}) and type
2a84440a03fb Small additions about tumme.
Mathias Dahl <mathias.dahl@gmail.com>
parents: 69737
diff changeset
2409 @kbd{C-t t} (@code{tumme-tag-files}). You will be prompted for a tag.
2a84440a03fb Small additions about tumme.
Mathias Dahl <mathias.dahl@gmail.com>
parents: 69737
diff changeset
2410 To mark files having a certain tag, type @kbd{C-t f}
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2411 (@code{tumme-mark-tagged-files}). After marking image files with a
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2412 certain tag, you can use @kbd{C-t d} to view them.
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2413
69784
2a84440a03fb Small additions about tumme.
Mathias Dahl <mathias.dahl@gmail.com>
parents: 69737
diff changeset
2414 You can also tag a file directly from the thumbnail buffer by typing
2a84440a03fb Small additions about tumme.
Mathias Dahl <mathias.dahl@gmail.com>
parents: 69737
diff changeset
2415 @kbd{t t} and you can remove a tag by typing @kbd{t r}. There is also
2a84440a03fb Small additions about tumme.
Mathias Dahl <mathias.dahl@gmail.com>
parents: 69737
diff changeset
2416 a special ``tag'' called ``comment'' for each file (it is not a tag in
2a84440a03fb Small additions about tumme.
Mathias Dahl <mathias.dahl@gmail.com>
parents: 69737
diff changeset
2417 the exact same sense as the other tags, it is handled slightly
2a84440a03fb Small additions about tumme.
Mathias Dahl <mathias.dahl@gmail.com>
parents: 69737
diff changeset
2418 different). That is used to enter a comment or description about the
2a84440a03fb Small additions about tumme.
Mathias Dahl <mathias.dahl@gmail.com>
parents: 69737
diff changeset
2419 image. You comment a file from the thumbnail buffer by typing
2a84440a03fb Small additions about tumme.
Mathias Dahl <mathias.dahl@gmail.com>
parents: 69737
diff changeset
2420 @kbd{c}. You will be prompted for a comment. Type @kbd{C-t c} to add
2a84440a03fb Small additions about tumme.
Mathias Dahl <mathias.dahl@gmail.com>
parents: 69737
diff changeset
2421 a comment from Dired (@code{tumme-dired-comment-files}).
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2422
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2423 Tumme also provides simple image manipulation. In the thumbnail
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2424 buffer, type @kbd{L} to rotate the original image 90 degrees anti
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2425 clockwise, and @kbd{R} to rotate it 90 degrees clockwise. This
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2426 rotation is lossless, and uses an external utility called JpegTRAN.
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2427
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2428 @node Dissociated Press, Amusements, Thumbnails, Top
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2429 @section Dissociated Press
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2430
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2431 @findex dissociated-press
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2432 @kbd{M-x dissociated-press} is a command for scrambling a file of text
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2433 either word by word or character by character. Starting from a buffer of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2434 straight English, it produces extremely amusing output. The input comes
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2435 from the current Emacs buffer. Dissociated Press writes its output in a
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2436 buffer named @samp{*Dissociation*}, and redisplays that buffer after every
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2437 couple of lines (approximately) so you can read the output as it comes out.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2438
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2439 Dissociated Press asks every so often whether to continue generating
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2440 output. Answer @kbd{n} to stop it. You can also stop at any time by
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2441 typing @kbd{C-g}. The dissociation output remains in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2442 @samp{*Dissociation*} buffer for you to copy elsewhere if you wish.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2443
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2444 @cindex presidentagon
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2445 Dissociated Press operates by jumping at random from one point in the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2446 buffer to another. In order to produce plausible output rather than
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2447 gibberish, it insists on a certain amount of overlap between the end of
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2448 one run of consecutive words or characters and the start of the next.
38869
8be184904f6c Don't use "print" for displaying a message.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38865
diff changeset
2449 That is, if it has just output `president' and then decides to jump
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2450 to a different point in the file, it might spot the `ent' in `pentagon'
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2451 and continue from there, producing `presidentagon'.@footnote{This
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2452 dissociword actually appeared during the Vietnam War, when it was very
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2453 appropriate. Bush has made it appropriate again.} Long sample texts
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2454 produce the best results.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2455
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2456 @cindex againformation
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2457 A positive argument to @kbd{M-x dissociated-press} tells it to operate
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2458 character by character, and specifies the number of overlap characters. A
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2459 negative argument tells it to operate word by word, and specifies the number
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2460 of overlap words. In this mode, whole words are treated as the elements to
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2461 be permuted, rather than characters. No argument is equivalent to an
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2462 argument of two. For your againformation, the output goes only into the
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2463 buffer @samp{*Dissociation*}. The buffer you start with is not changed.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2464
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2465 @cindex Markov chain
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2466 @cindex ignoriginal
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2467 @cindex techniquitous
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2468 Dissociated Press produces results fairly like those of a Markov
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2469 chain based on a frequency table constructed from the sample text. It
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2470 is, however, an independent, ignoriginal invention. Dissociated Press
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2471 techniquitously copies several consecutive characters from the sample
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2472 between random choices, whereas a Markov chain would choose randomly
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2473 for each word or character. This makes for more plausible sounding
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2474 results, and runs faster.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2475
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2476 @cindex outragedy
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2477 @cindex buggestion
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2478 @cindex properbose
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2479 @cindex mustatement
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2480 @cindex developediment
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2481 @cindex userenced
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2482 It is a mustatement that too much use of Dissociated Press can be a
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2483 developediment to your real work, sometimes to the point of outragedy.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2484 And keep dissociwords out of your documentation, if you want it to be well
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2485 userenced and properbose. Have fun. Your buggestions are welcome.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2486
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2487 @node Amusements, Customization, Dissociated Press, Top
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2488 @section Other Amusements
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2489 @cindex boredom
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2490 @findex hanoi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2491 @findex yow
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2492 @findex gomoku
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2493 @cindex tower of Hanoi
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2494
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2495 If you are a little bit bored, you can try @kbd{M-x hanoi}. If you are
38740
5c0509ab3f20 Minor cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 38599
diff changeset
2496 considerably bored, give it a numeric argument. If you are very, very
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2497 bored, try an argument of 9. Sit back and watch.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2498
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2499 @cindex Go Moku
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2500 If you want a little more personal involvement, try @kbd{M-x gomoku},
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2501 which plays the game Go Moku with you.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2502
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2503 @findex blackbox
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2504 @findex mpuz
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2505 @findex 5x5
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2506 @cindex puzzles
69737
cd14e584d88e Many cleanups.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 68639
diff changeset
2507 @kbd{M-x blackbox}, @kbd{M-x mpuz} and @kbd{M-x 5x5} are puzzles.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2508 @code{blackbox} challenges you to determine the location of objects
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2509 inside a box by tomography. @code{mpuz} displays a multiplication
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2510 puzzle with letters standing for digits in a code that you must
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2511 guess---to guess a value, type a letter and then the digit you think it
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2512 stands for. The aim of @code{5x5} is to fill in all the squares.
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2513
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2514 @findex decipher
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2515 @cindex ciphers
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2516 @cindex cryptanalysis
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2517 @kbd{M-x decipher} helps you to cryptanalyze a buffer which is encrypted
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2518 in a simple monoalphabetic substitution cipher.
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2519
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2520 @findex dunnet
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2521 @kbd{M-x dunnet} runs an adventure-style exploration game, which is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2522 a bigger sort of puzzle.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2523
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2524 @findex lm
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2525 @cindex landmark game
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2526 @kbd{M-x lm} runs a relatively non-participatory game in which a robot
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2527 attempts to maneuver towards a tree at the center of the window based on
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2528 unique olfactory cues from each of the four directions.
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2529
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2530 @findex life
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2531 @cindex Life
36185
62cf166239f3 Change in quoting.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 36168
diff changeset
2532 @kbd{M-x life} runs Conway's ``Life'' cellular automaton.
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2533
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2534 @findex morse-region
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2535 @findex unmorse-region
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2536 @cindex Morse code
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2537 @cindex --/---/.-./.../.
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2538 @kbd{M-x morse-region} converts text in a region to Morse code and
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2539 @kbd{M-x unmorse-region} converts it back. No cause for remorse.
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2540
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2541 @findex pong
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2542 @cindex Pong game
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2543 @kbd{M-x pong} plays a Pong-like game, bouncing the ball off opposing
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2544 bats.
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2545
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2546 @findex solitaire
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2547 @cindex solitaire
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2548 @kbd{M-x solitaire} plays a game of solitaire in which you jump pegs
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2549 across other pegs.
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2550
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2551 @findex studlify-region
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2552 @cindex StudlyCaps
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2553 @kbd{M-x studlify-region} studlify-cases the region, producing
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2554 text like this:
30856
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2555
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2556 @example
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2557 M-x stUdlIfY-RegioN stUdlIfY-CaSeS thE region.
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2558 @end example
c17c1380a43d (Emacs Server): emacs.bash
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 29107
diff changeset
2559
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2560 @findex tetris
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2561 @cindex Tetris
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2562 @findex snake
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2563 @cindex Snake
36168
df827c1def99 Clean up close-quote punctuation.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents: 35648
diff changeset
2564 @kbd{M-x tetris} runs an implementation of the well-known Tetris game.
27210
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2565 Likewise, @kbd{M-x snake} provides an implementation of Snake.
ac3a8cb1ce25 PostScript <- Postscript.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 26290
diff changeset
2566
25829
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2567 When you are frustrated, try the famous Eliza program. Just do
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2568 @kbd{M-x doctor}. End each input by typing @key{RET} twice.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2569
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2570 @cindex Zippy
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
diff changeset
2571 When you are feeling strange, type @kbd{M-x yow}.
30862
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 30856
diff changeset
2572
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 30856
diff changeset
2573 @findex zone
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 30856
diff changeset
2574 The command @kbd{M-x zone} plays games with the display when Emacs is
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents: 30856
diff changeset
2575 idle.
52401
695cf19ef79e Add arch taglines
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 52378
diff changeset
2576
56807
d2c0e48f4d5a Adapt sectioning in Info to the node structure.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 56222
diff changeset
2577 @ifnottex
d2c0e48f4d5a Adapt sectioning in Info to the node structure.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 56222
diff changeset
2578 @lowersections
d2c0e48f4d5a Adapt sectioning in Info to the node structure.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 56222
diff changeset
2579 @end ifnottex
d2c0e48f4d5a Adapt sectioning in Info to the node structure.
Luc Teirlinck <teirllm@auburn.edu>
parents: 56222
diff changeset
2580
52401
695cf19ef79e Add arch taglines
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 52378
diff changeset
2581 @ignore
695cf19ef79e Add arch taglines
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 52378
diff changeset
2582 arch-tag: 8f094220-c0d5-4e9e-af7d-3e0da8187474
695cf19ef79e Add arch taglines
Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
parents: 52378
diff changeset
2583 @end ignore